blob: dc43003e84a4a7a6d333ba9b638d58380a392dfc [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau991b4782015-10-13 21:48:10 +02005 version 1.7
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau41d5e3a2016-08-14 12:25:21 +02007 2016/08/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
109
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200110
1111. Quick reminder about HTTP
112----------------------------
113
114When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
115fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
116on almost anything found in the contents.
117
118However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
119formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
120correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
121
122
1231.1. The HTTP transaction model
124-------------------------------
125
126The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100127to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
129connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
130will involve a new connection :
131
132 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
133
134In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
135establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
136by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
137length.
138
139Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
140to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
141however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
142response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
143header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
144
145 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
146
147Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
148power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
149but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200150a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151
152A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
153keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
154second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
155page :
156
157 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
158
159This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
160latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
161correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
162the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100163server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100165By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
166connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
167leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
168start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100170HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
171 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
172 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
173 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
174 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
175 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
176 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
177
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
1791.2. HTTP request
180-----------------
181
182First, let's consider this HTTP request :
183
184 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100185 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200186 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
187 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
188 3 User-agent: my small browser
189 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
190 5 Accept: image/png
191
192
1931.2.1. The Request line
194-----------------------
195
196Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
197
198 - a METHOD : GET
199 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
200 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
201
202All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
203which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
204followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
205is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
206desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
207the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
208
209The URI itself can have several forms :
210
211 - A "relative URI" :
212
213 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
214
215 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
216 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
217
218 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
219
220 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
221
222 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
223 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
224 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
225 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
226 must accept this form too.
227
228 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
229 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
230 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200232 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
233 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
234 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
235 other protocols too.
236
237In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
238mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
239on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
240It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
241specific to the language, framework or application in use.
242
243
2441.2.2. The request headers
245--------------------------
246
247The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
248beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
249an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
250Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
251values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
252encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
253the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
254define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
255
256Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
257their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
258"Connection:" header).
259
260The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
261that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
262is one valid form of empty line.
263
264Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
265headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
266about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
267application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
268
269Important note:
270 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
271 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
272 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
273 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
274
275
2761.3. HTTP response
277------------------
278
279An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
280messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
281
282 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100283 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
285 2 Content-length: 350
286 3 Content-Type: text/html
287
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200288As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
289codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
290response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100291continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
292the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
293following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
294sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
295(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
296correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
297such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
298state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
299over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
300if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
301information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200302
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200303
3041.3.1. The Response line
305------------------------
306
307Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
308
309 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
310 - a status code : 200
311 - a reason : OK
312
313The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200314 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200315 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
316 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
317 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
318 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
319
320Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100321"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200322found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
323messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
324or "Authentication Required".
325
326Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
327
328 Code When / reason
329 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
330 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
331 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100333 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
334 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200335 400 for an invalid or too large request
336 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
337 accessing the stats page)
338 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
339 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
340 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
341 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
342 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
343 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
344 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
345 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
346 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
347
348The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3494.2).
350
351
3521.3.2. The response headers
353---------------------------
354
355Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
356the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
357details.
358
359
3602. Configuring HAProxy
361----------------------
362
3632.1. Configuration file format
364------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200365
366HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
367
368 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
369 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
370 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
371 "frontend" and "backend".
372
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100373The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
374referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200375delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100376
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003782.2. Quoting and escaping
379-------------------------
380
381HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
382many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
383with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
384single quotes.
385
386If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
387them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
388escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
389
390Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
391
392 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
393 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
394 \\ to use a backslash
395 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
396 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
397
398Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
399the interpretation of:
400
401 space as a parameter separator
402 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
403 # hash as a comment start
404
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200405Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
406-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
407backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
408
409Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200410quoting.
411
412Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
413nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
414
415Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
416equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
417
418 Example:
419 # those are equivalents:
420 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
421 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
422 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
423 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
425
426 # those are equivalents:
427 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
428 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
431
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004332.3. Environment variables
434--------------------------
435
436HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
437interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
438configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
439optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
440shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
441underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
442
443 Example:
444
445 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
446
447 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
448
449 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
450
451
4522.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200453----------------
454
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100455Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100456values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
457otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
458numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
459for every keyword. Supported units are :
460
461 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
462 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
463 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
464 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
465 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
466 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
467
468
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004692.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200470-------------
471
472 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
473 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
474 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
475 global
476 daemon
477 maxconn 256
478
479 defaults
480 mode http
481 timeout connect 5000ms
482 timeout client 50000ms
483 timeout server 50000ms
484
485 frontend http-in
486 bind *:80
487 default_backend servers
488
489 backend servers
490 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
491
492
493 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
494 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
495 global
496 daemon
497 maxconn 256
498
499 defaults
500 mode http
501 timeout connect 5000ms
502 timeout client 50000ms
503 timeout server 50000ms
504
505 listen http-in
506 bind *:80
507 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
508
509
510Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
511
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100512 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200513
514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005153. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516--------------------
517
518Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
519are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
520of them have command-line equivalents.
521
522The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
523
524 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200525 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200527 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200528 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200529 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200530 - description
531 - deviceatlas-json-file
532 - deviceatlas-log-level
533 - deviceatlas-separator
534 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900535 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200536 - gid
537 - group
538 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200539 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100540 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200542 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100545 - presetenv
546 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547 - uid
548 - ulimit-n
549 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100550 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200551 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200552 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
553 - ssl-default-bind-options
554 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-server-options
556 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100557 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100558 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100559 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100560 - 51degrees-data-file
561 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200562 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200563 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100564
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200565 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200566 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200568 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100569 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100570 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100571 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200572 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200573 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200574 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200575 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200576 - noepoll
577 - nokqueue
578 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300580 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000581 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200582 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200583 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200584 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - tune.buffers.limit
586 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200587 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200588 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100589 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100590 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200591 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100592 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100593 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100594 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100595 - tune.lua.session-timeout
596 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200597 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100598 - tune.maxaccept
599 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200600 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200601 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200602 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100603 - tune.rcvbuf.client
604 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100605 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100606 - tune.sndbuf.client
607 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100608 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100609 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200610 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100611 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200612 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200613 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200614 - tune.vars.global-max-size
615 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
616 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
617 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100618 - tune.zlib.memlevel
619 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100620
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200621 * Debugging
622 - debug
623 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200624
625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006263.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627------------------------------------
628
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200629ca-base <dir>
630 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200631 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
632 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634chroot <jail dir>
635 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
636 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
637 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
638 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
639 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
640 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100641
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100642cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
643 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
644 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
645 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100646 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
647 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
648 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
649 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
650 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
651 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
652 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
653 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
654 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
655 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100656
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200657crt-base <dir>
658 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
659 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
660 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
661
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200662daemon
663 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
664 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
665 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
666
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200667deviceatlas-json-file <path>
668 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
669 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
670
671deviceatlas-log-level <value>
672 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
673 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
674
675deviceatlas-separator <char>
676 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
677 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
678
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100679deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200680 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
681 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
682 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100683
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900684external-check
685 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
686 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
687 See "option external-check".
688
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200689gid <number>
690 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
691 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
692 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100693 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
694 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200695 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100696
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200697group <group name>
698 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
699 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100700
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200701log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
703 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100704 configured with "log global".
705
706 <address> can be one of:
707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100708 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100709 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
710 port).
711
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100712 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
713 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
714 port).
715
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100716 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
717 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
718 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
719 writeable).
720
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200721 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
722 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100723
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200724 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
725 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
726 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
727 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
728 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
729 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
730 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
731 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
732 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
733 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
734 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
735
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200736 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
737 one of the following :
738
739 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
740 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
741
742 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
743 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200746
747 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
748 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
749 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
750
751 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200752 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
753 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
754 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
755 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
756 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
757 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200758
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200759 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200760
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100761log-send-hostname [<string>]
762 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
763 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
764 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
765 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
766 the logs.
767
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000768log-tag <string>
769 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
770 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
771 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100772 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000773
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100774lua-load <file>
775 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
776 used multiple times.
777
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200778nbproc <number>
779 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
780 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
781 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
782 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
783 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
784
785pidfile <pidfile>
786 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
787 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
788 starting the process. See also "daemon".
789
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100790presetenv <name> <value>
791 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
792 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
793 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
794 and "unsetenv".
795
796resetenv [<name> ...]
797 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
798 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
799 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
800 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
801 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
802 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
803 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
804 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
805
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100806stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200807 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
808 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
809 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
810 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
811 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
812 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100813 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200814 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
815 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200817server-state-base <directory>
818 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200819 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
820 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200821
822server-state-file <file>
823 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
824 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
825 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
826 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
827 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
828 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
829 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
830 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200831 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
832 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834setenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
837 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100840ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
842 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300843 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100844 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
845 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
846 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
847 "bind" keyword for more information.
848
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100849ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
852 keyword to see available options.
853
854 Example:
855 global
856 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
857
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100858ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
860 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300861 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100862 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
863 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
864 information.
865
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100866ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
869 keyword to see available options.
870
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200871ssl-dh-param-file <file>
872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
873 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
874 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
875 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
876 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200877 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
878 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
879 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
880 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200881 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
882 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
883 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
884
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100885ssl-server-verify [none|required]
886 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
887 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
888 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
889
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200890stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
891 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
892 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
893 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200894 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
895 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200896
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200897 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
898 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
899 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200900
901stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
902 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
903 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100904 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200905
906stats maxconn <connections>
907 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
908 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
909
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200910uid <number>
911 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
912 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
913 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
914 one. See also "gid" and "user".
915
916ulimit-n <number>
917 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
918 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
919 option.
920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100921unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
922 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
923
924 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
925 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
926 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
927 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
928 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
929 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
930 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
931 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
932 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
933 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
934
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100935unsetenv [<name> ...]
936 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
937 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
938 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
939 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
940 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
941 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
942 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200944user <user name>
945 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
946 See also "uid" and "group".
947
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200948node <name>
949 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
950
951 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
952 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
953 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
954 traffic.
955
956description <text>
957 Add a text that describes the instance.
958
959 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
960 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
961 "<" and ">" characters.
962
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010096351degrees-data-file <file path>
964 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
965 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
966
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200967 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100968 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
969
97051degrees-property-name-list [<string>]
971 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
972 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
973 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
974
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200975 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100976 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
977
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020097851degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100979 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
980 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
981
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200982 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
983 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
984
98551degrees-cache-size <number>
986 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
987 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
988 By default, this cache is disabled.
989
990 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100991 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
992
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009943.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995-----------------------
996
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200997max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
998 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
999 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1000 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1001 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1002 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1003 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1004 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1005 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007maxconn <number>
1008 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1009 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1010 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001011 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1012 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1013 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1014 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001015 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1016 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1017 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1018 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1019 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001020
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001021maxconnrate <number>
1022 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1023 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1024 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1025 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1026 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1027 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1028 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1029 fairness.
1030
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001031maxcomprate <number>
1032 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001033 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001034 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1035 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1036 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1037 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1038 default value.
1039
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001040maxcompcpuusage <number>
1041 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1042 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1043 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1044 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1045 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1046 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1047 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1048 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1049
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001050maxpipes <number>
1051 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1052 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1053 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1054 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1055 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1056 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1057
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001058maxsessrate <number>
1059 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1060 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1061 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1062 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1063 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1064 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1065 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1066 fairness.
1067
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001068maxsslconn <number>
1069 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1070 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1071 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1072 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1073 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1074 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1075 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001076 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1077 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1078 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1079 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1080 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1081 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1082 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001083
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001084maxsslrate <number>
1085 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1086 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1087 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1088 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1089 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1090 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1091 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1092 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1093 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1094 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1095
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001096maxzlibmem <number>
1097 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1098 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1099 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001100 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1101 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1102 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1103
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104noepoll
1105 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1106 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001107 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
1109nokqueue
1110 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1111 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1112 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1113
1114nopoll
1115 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1116 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001117 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001118 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001119
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001120nosplice
1121 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1122 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1123 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001124 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001125 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1126 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1127 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1128 "option splice-response".
1129
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001130nogetaddrinfo
1131 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1132 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1133
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001134noreuseport
1135 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1136 command line argument "-dR".
1137
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001138spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001139 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1140 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1141 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1142 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1143 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1144 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001145
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001146tune.buffers.limit <number>
1147 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1148 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1149 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1150 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1151 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1152 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1153 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1154 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1155 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1156 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1157 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1158 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1159 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1160 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1161 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1162
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001163tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1164 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1165 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1166 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1167 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1168
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001169tune.bufsize <number>
1170 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1171 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1172 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1173 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1174 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1175 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1176 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1177 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001178 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1179 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1180 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001181
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001182tune.chksize <number>
1183 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1184 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1185 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1186 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1187 checks whenever possible.
1188
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001189tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1190 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1191 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1192 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1193 this value. The default value is 1.
1194
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001195tune.http.cookielen <number>
1196 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1197 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1198 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1199 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1200 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1201 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1202 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1203 to change this value.
1204
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001205tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1206 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1207 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1208 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1209 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1210 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1211 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1212 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1213 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1214 limit too high.
1215
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001216tune.idletimer <timeout>
1217 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1218 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1219 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1220 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1221 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1222 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1223 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1224 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1225 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1226
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001227tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1228 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
1229 instructions executed. This permits interruptng a long script and allows the
1230 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1231 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1232 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1233 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1234 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1235
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001236tune.lua.maxmem
1237 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1238 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1239 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1240 memory.
1241
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001242tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1243 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001244 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1245 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1246 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001247
1248tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1249 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1250 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1251 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1252 check servers.
1253
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001254tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1255 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1256 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1257 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1258 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1259
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001260tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001261 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1262 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1263 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1264 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1265 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1266 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1267 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1268 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1269 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1270 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001271
1272tune.maxpollevents <number>
1273 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1274 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1275 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1276 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1277 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1278
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279tune.maxrewrite <number>
1280 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1281 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1282 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1283 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1284 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1285 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1286 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1287 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1288 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1289 bufsize.
1290
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001291tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1292 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1293 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1294 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1295 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1296 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1297 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1298 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1299 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1300 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1301 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1302 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1303 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1304 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1305 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1306 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1307 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1308 setting this parameter to 0.
1309
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001310tune.pipesize <number>
1311 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1312 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1313 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1314 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1315 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1316 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1317
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001318tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1319tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1320 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1321 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1322 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1323 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1324 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1325 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1326 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1327
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001328tune.recv_enough <number>
1329 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1330 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1331 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1332 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1333 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1334
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001335tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1336tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1337 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1338 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1339 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1340 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1341 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1342 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1343 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1344 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1345 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1346 notifying haproxy again.
1347
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001348tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001349 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1350 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1351 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001352 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001353 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1354 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1355 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1356 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1357 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001358 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1359 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001360
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001361tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1362 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1363 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1364 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1365 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1366 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1367 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1368
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001369tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1370 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001371 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001372 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1373 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1374 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1375 being used for too long.
1376
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001377tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1378 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1379 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1380 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1381 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1382 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1383 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1384 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1385 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1386 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1387 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001388 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1389 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001390
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001391tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1392 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1393 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1394 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1395 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1396 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1397 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1398 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001399 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1400 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001401
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001402tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1403 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1404 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1405 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1406 1000 entries.
1407
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001408tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
1409tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1410tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1411tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001412 These four tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1413 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available
1414 for all scopes. "sess" limits the memory for the session scope, "txn" for
1415 the transaction scope, and "reqres" limits the memory for each request or
1416 response processing.
1417 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits
1418 include the finer grained ones: "sess" includes "txn", and "txn" includes
1419 "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001420
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001421 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1422 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1423 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1424 all available space is consumed.
1425 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1426 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1427 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001428
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001429tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1430 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001431 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001432 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1433 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1434 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1435
1436tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1437 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1438 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1439 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1440 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001441
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014423.3. Debugging
1443--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001444
1445debug
1446 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1447 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1448 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1449 system startup.
1450
1451quiet
1452 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1453 line argument "-q".
1454
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014563.4. Userlists
1457--------------
1458It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1459http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1460it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1461
1462userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001463 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001464 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1465
1466group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001467 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001468 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1469 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1470
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001471user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1472 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001473 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1474 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001475 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1476 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001477 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001478 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001479
1480
1481 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001482 userlist L1
1483 group G1 users tiger,scott
1484 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001485
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001486 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1487 user scott insecure-password elgato
1488 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001489
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001490 userlist L2
1491 group G1
1492 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001493
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001494 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1495 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1496 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001497
1498 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001499
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001500
15013.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001502----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001503It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1504several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1505instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1506values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1507automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1508In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1509using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1510tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1511reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1512Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1513that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1514each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001515
1516peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001517 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001518 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1519
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001520disabled
1521 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1522 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1523 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1524
1525enable
1526 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1527
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001528peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1529 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1530 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1531 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1532 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1533 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1534 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1535
1536 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1537 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1538
1539 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1540 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1541 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1542 across all peers.
1543
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001544 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1545 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001546
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001547 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001548 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001549 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1550 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1551 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001552
1553 backend mybackend
1554 mode tcp
1555 balance roundrobin
1556 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1557 stick on src
1558
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001559 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1560 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001561
1562
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090015633.6. Mailers
1564------------
1565It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1566If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1567in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1568
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001569mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001570 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1571 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1572
1573mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1574 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1575
1576 Example:
1577 mailers mymailers
1578 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1579 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1580
1581 backend mybackend
1582 mode tcp
1583 balance roundrobin
1584
1585 email-alert mailers mymailers
1586 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1587 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1588
1589 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1590 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1591
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001592timeout mail <time>
1593 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1594 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1595 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1596 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1597
1598 Example:
1599 mailers mymailers
1600 timeout mail 20s
1601 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016034. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001604----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001606Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001607 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608 - frontend <name>
1609 - backend <name>
1610 - listen <name>
1611
1612A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1613its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1614section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001615section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001616
1617A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1618connections.
1619
1620A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1621to forward incoming connections.
1622
1623A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1624parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1625
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001626All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1627'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1628case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1629
1630Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1631logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1632proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1633However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1634name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1635
1636Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1637and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001638bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001639protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1640modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1641arbitrary criteria.
1642
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001643In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1644a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1645the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1646
1647 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1648 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1649 between responses and new requests.
1650
1651 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1652 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1653 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1654 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1655
1656 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1657 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1658 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1659
1660 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1661 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1662 client-facing connection remains open.
1663
1664 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1665 after the end of the response.
1666
1667The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1668frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1669following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1670weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1671
1672 Backend mode
1673
1674 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1675 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1676 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1677 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1678 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1679 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1680 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1681 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1682 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1683 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1684 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1685
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001686
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016884.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1689--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001690
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001691The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1692limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1693they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1694limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001695marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001696option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001697and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1698with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1699specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001701
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001702 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1703------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1704acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001705appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001706backlog X X X -
1707balance X - X X
1708bind - X X -
1709bind-process X X X X
1710block - X X X
1711capture cookie - X X -
1712capture request header - X X -
1713capture response header - X X -
1714clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001715compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001716contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1717cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001718declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001719default-server X - X X
1720default_backend X X X -
1721description - X X X
1722disabled X X X X
1723dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001724email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001725email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001726email-alert mailers X X X X
1727email-alert myhostname X X X X
1728email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001729enabled X X X X
1730errorfile X X X X
1731errorloc X X X X
1732errorloc302 X X X X
1733-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1734errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001735force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001736filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001737fullconn X - X X
1738grace X X X X
1739hash-type X - X X
1740http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001741http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001742http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001743http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001744http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001745http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001746http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001747id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001748ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001749load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001750log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001751log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001752log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001753log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001754max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001755maxconn X X X -
1756mode X X X X
1757monitor fail - X X -
1758monitor-net X X X -
1759monitor-uri X X X -
1760option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1761option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1762option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1763option allbackups (*) X - X X
1764option checkcache (*) X - X X
1765option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1766option contstats (*) X X X -
1767option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1768option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1769option forceclose (*) X X X X
1770-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1771option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001772option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001773option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001774option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001775option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001776option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001777option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001778option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001779option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1780option httpchk X - X X
1781option httpclose (*) X X X X
1782option httplog X X X X
1783option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001784option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001785option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001786option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001787option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1788option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1789option logasap (*) X X X -
1790option mysql-check X - X X
1791option nolinger (*) X X X X
1792option originalto X X X X
1793option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001794option pgsql-check X - X X
1795option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001796option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001797option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001798option smtpchk X - X X
1799option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1800option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1801option splice-request (*) X X X X
1802option splice-response (*) X X X X
1803option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1804option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1805-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001806option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001807option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1808option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1809option tcpka X X X X
1810option tcplog X X X X
1811option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001812external-check command X - X X
1813external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001814persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1815rate-limit sessions X X X -
1816redirect - X X X
1817redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1818redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1819reqadd - X X X
1820reqallow - X X X
1821reqdel - X X X
1822reqdeny - X X X
1823reqiallow - X X X
1824reqidel - X X X
1825reqideny - X X X
1826reqipass - X X X
1827reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001828reqitarpit - X X X
1829reqpass - X X X
1830reqrep - X X X
1831-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832reqtarpit - X X X
1833retries X - X X
1834rspadd - X X X
1835rspdel - X X X
1836rspdeny - X X X
1837rspidel - X X X
1838rspideny - X X X
1839rspirep - X X X
1840rsprep - X X X
1841server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001842server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001843source X - X X
1844srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001845stats admin - X X X
1846stats auth X X X X
1847stats enable X X X X
1848stats hide-version X X X X
1849stats http-request - X X X
1850stats realm X X X X
1851stats refresh X X X X
1852stats scope X X X X
1853stats show-desc X X X X
1854stats show-legends X X X X
1855stats show-node X X X X
1856stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001857-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1858stick match - - X X
1859stick on - - X X
1860stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001861stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001862stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001863tcp-check connect - - X X
1864tcp-check expect - - X X
1865tcp-check send - - X X
1866tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001867tcp-request connection - X X -
1868tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001869tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001870tcp-response content - - X X
1871tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001872timeout check X - X X
1873timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001874timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001875timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1876timeout connect X - X X
1877timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1878timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1879timeout http-request X X X X
1880timeout queue X - X X
1881timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001882timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1884timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001885timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001887unique-id-format X X X -
1888unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001889use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001890use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1892 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001893
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001894
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018954.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1896---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001897
1898This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1899
1900
1901acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1902 Declare or complete an access list.
1903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1904 no | yes | yes | yes
1905 Example:
1906 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1907 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1908 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1909
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001910 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001911
1912
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001913appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1914 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001915 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1917 no | no | yes | yes
1918 Arguments :
1919 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1920 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1921
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001922 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001923 checked in each cookie value.
1924
1925 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1926 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1927 milliseconds.
1928
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001929 request-learn
1930 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1931 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1932 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1933 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1934 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1935 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1936
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001937 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1938 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1939 data following this prefix.
1940
1941 Example :
1942 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1943
1944 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1945 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1946
1947 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1948 2 modes are currently supported :
1949 - path-parameters :
1950 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1951 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1952 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1953 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1954 - query-string :
1955 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1956 query string.
1957
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001958 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
1959 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
1960 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001961
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001962 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1963 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001964
1965
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001966backlog <conns>
1967 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1969 yes | yes | yes | no
1970 Arguments :
1971 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1972 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001973 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001974
1975 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1976 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1977 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1978 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1979 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1980 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1981 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1982 backlog parameter.
1983
1984 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1985 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1986 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1987
1988 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1989
1990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001991balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001992balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1995 yes | no | yes | yes
1996 Arguments :
1997 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1998 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1999 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2000 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2001
2002 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2003 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2004 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2005 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002006 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002007 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002008 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2009 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2010 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2011 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2012 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2013 it, so that you don't worry.
2014
2015 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2016 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2017 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2018 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2019 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2020 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2021 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2022 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002023
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002024 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2025 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2026 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2027 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2028 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2029 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2030 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2031 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2032
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002033 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002034 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002035 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2036 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002037 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002038 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2039 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2040 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2041 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2042 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002043 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2044 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2045 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2046 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2047 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2048 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002049
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002050 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2051 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2052 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2053 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2054 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2055 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2056 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2057 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002058 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002060 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2061 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2062 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002063
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002064 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2065 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2066 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2067 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2068 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2069 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2070 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2071 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2072 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2073 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2074 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2075 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002076
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002077 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002078 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2079 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2080 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2081 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2082 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2083 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2084 URIs start with a leading "/".
2085
2086 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2087 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2088 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2089 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2090
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002091 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002092 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2093
2094 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002095 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2096 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002097 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2098 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2099 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2100 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002101 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002102 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2103 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002104
2105 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2106 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2107 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2108 server will receive the request.
2109
2110 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2111 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2112 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2113 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2114 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002115 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2116 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2117 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002118
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002119 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2120 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2121 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2122 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2123 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002124
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002125 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002126 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2127 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2128 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2129
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002130 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2131 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2132 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2133
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002134 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002135 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002136 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2137 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2138 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2139 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2140 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2141 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002142 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002143 used instead.
2144
2145 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2146 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2147 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2148 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2149
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002150 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2151 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2152 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2153
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002154 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002157 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2158 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002159
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002160 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2161 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2162 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163
2164 Examples :
2165 balance roundrobin
2166 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002167 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002168 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2169 balance hdr(host)
2170 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002171
2172 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2173 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2174
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002175 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002176 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2177 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2178 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2179 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2180
2181 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2182 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2183 defaults to 16 kB.
2184
2185 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2186 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2187
2188 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2189 Round Robin.
2190
2191 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2192 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2193 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2194 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2195
2196 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2197
2198 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002199 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002200 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2201 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2202 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002203
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002204 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002205
2206
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002207bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2208bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002209 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2210 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2211 no | yes | yes | no
2212 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002213 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2214 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2215 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2216 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002217 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002218 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2219 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2220 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2221 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2222 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2223 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2224 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002225 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2226 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2227 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2228 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2229 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2230 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2231 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002232 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2233 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2234 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002235 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2236 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2237 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002238
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002239 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2240 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002241 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2242 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2243 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002244 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2245 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2246 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2247 the range.
2248
2249 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2250 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2251 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2252 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2253 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2254 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2255 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002256 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002257 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002258
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002259 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2260 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2261 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2262 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2263 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2264 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2265 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2266 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2267
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002268 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2269 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2270 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2271 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002273 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2274 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2275 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2276 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2277 in a frontend.
2278
2279 Example :
2280 listen http_proxy
2281 bind :80,:443
2282 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002283 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002284
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002285 listen http_https_proxy
2286 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002287 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002288
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002289 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2290 bind ipv6@:80
2291 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2292 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2293
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002294 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002295 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002296
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002297 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2298 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2299 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2300 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2301 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2302
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002303 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002304 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002305
2306
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002307bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002308 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2310 yes | yes | yes | yes
2311 Arguments :
2312 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2313 may be used to override a default value.
2314
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002315 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002316 option may be combined with other numbers.
2317
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002318 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002319 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2320 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2321 missing from all processes.
2322
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002323 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002324 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002325 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2326 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2327 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2328 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002329
2330 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2331 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2332 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2333 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2334 and 'even' instances.
2335
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002336 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2337 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2338 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2339 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002340
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002341 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2342 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2343
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002344 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2345 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2346 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2347
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002348 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2349 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2350
2351 Example :
2352 listen app_ip1
2353 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002354 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002355
2356 listen app_ip2
2357 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002358 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002359
2360 listen management
2361 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002362 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002363
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002364 listen management
2365 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2366 bind-process 1-4
2367
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002368 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002369
2370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002371block { if | unless } <condition>
2372 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2374 no | yes | yes | yes
2375
2376 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2377 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002378 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002379 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002380 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2381 "block" statements per instance.
2382
2383 Example:
2384 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2385 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2386 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2387 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002389 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
2391
2392capture cookie <name> len <length>
2393 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2395 no | yes | yes | no
2396 Arguments :
2397 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2398 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2399 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2400 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2401 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2402
2403 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2404 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2405 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2406 right if it exceeds <length>.
2407
2408 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2409 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2410 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2411 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2412
2413 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2414 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2415 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2416
2417 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2418 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2419 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002420 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2421 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2422 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002423
2424 Example:
2425 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2426
2427 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002428 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002429
2430
2431capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002432 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2434 no | yes | yes | no
2435 Arguments :
2436 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002437 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002438 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2439 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2440 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2441
2442 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2443 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2444 it exceeds <length>.
2445
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002446 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2448 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002449 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2450 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2451 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2452 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002453 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002454 environments to find where the request came from.
2455
2456 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2457 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2458 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2459 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002460
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002461 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2462 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2463 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2464 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2465 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002466
2467 Example:
2468 capture request header Host len 15
2469 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002470 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002471
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002472 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002473 about logging.
2474
2475
2476capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002477 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2479 no | yes | yes | no
2480 Arguments :
2481 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002482 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002483 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2484 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2485 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2486
2487 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2488 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2489 it exceeds <length>.
2490
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002491 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2493 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2494 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002495 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2496 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2497 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2498 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002500 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2501 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2502 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2503 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2504 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002505
2506 Example:
2507 capture response header Content-length len 9
2508 capture response header Location len 15
2509
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002510 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002511 about logging.
2512
2513
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002514clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002515 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2516 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2517 yes | yes | yes | no
2518 Arguments :
2519 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2520 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2521 as explained at the top of this document.
2522
2523 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2524 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2525 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2526 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2527 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2528 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2529 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2530 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002531 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2533 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2534
2535 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2536 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2537 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2538 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2539 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2540 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2541
2542 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2543 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2544
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002545 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2546 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002548compression algo <algorithm> ...
2549compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002550compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002551 Enable HTTP compression.
2552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2553 yes | yes | yes | yes
2554 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002555 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2556 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2557 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2558
2559 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002560 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2561 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2562 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002563
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002564 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002565 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002566
2567 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2568 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2569 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2570 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2571 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002572 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002573
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002574 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2575 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2576 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2577 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2578 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2579 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2580 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002581 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002582
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002583 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002584 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002585 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2586 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2587 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2588 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2589 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002590
2591 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2592 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2593 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2594 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2595 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002596 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2597 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2598 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2599 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2600 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002601 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2602 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002603
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002604 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002605 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2606 "Accept-Encoding" header
2607 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002608 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002609 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2610 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002611 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2612 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2613 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2614 "multipart"
2615 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2616 header
2617 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2618 and later
2619 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2620 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002621
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002622 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2623 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002624
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002625 Examples :
2626 compression algo gzip
2627 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002629
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002630contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2632 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2633 yes | no | yes | yes
2634 Arguments :
2635 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2636 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2637 as explained at the top of this document.
2638
2639 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002640 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002641 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002642 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2643 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2644 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2645 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2646
2647 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2648 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2649 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2650 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2651 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2652 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2653
2654 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2655 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2656 instead.
2657
2658 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2659 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2660
2661
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002662cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002663 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2664 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002665 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2667 yes | no | yes | yes
2668 Arguments :
2669 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2670 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2671 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2672 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2673 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2674 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2675 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2676 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2677 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2678
2679 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2680 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2681 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2682 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2683 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2684 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002685 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2686 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2687 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2688 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2689 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690
2691 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002692 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002693
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002694 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002695 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2696 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2697 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2698 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2699 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2700 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2701 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2702 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2703 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2704 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002705
2706 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2707 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2708 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2709 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2710 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2711 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2712 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2713 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2714 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002715 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002716 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2717 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2718 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002719
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002720 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2721 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2722 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002723 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2724 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2725 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2726 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002727 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2728 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2729 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002730
2731 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2732 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2733 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2734 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2735 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2736 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2737 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2738 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2739 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2740
2741 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2742 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2743 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2744 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2745 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2746 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2747 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2748 persistence cookie in the cache.
2749 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2750
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002751 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2752 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2753 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2754 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2755 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2756 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2757 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2758 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2759 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2760 they logout.
2761
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002762 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2763 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2764 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2765 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2766
2767 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2768 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2769 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2770 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2771 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2772 this attribute.
2773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002774 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002775 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002776 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2777 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2778 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2779 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2780 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2781 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002782
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002783 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2784 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2785 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2786 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2787 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2788 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2789 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2790 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2791 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2792 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2793 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2794 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2795 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2796 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2797 the site.
2798
2799 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2800 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2801 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2802 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2803 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2804 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2805 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2806 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2807 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2808 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2809 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2810 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2811 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2812 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2813 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2814 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002816 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2817 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2818 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2819 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002820
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821 Examples :
2822 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2823 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2824 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002825 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002826
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002827 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002829
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002830declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2831 Declares a capture slot.
2832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2833 no | yes | yes | no
2834 Arguments:
2835 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2836
2837 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2838 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2839 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2840 for use in the response.
2841
2842 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002843 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002844 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2845
2846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002847default-server [param*]
2848 Change default options for a server in a backend
2849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2850 yes | no | yes | yes
2851 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002852 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2853 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2854 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2855 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002856
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002857 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002858 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2859
2860 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002861
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002862
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002863default_backend <backend>
2864 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2866 yes | yes | yes | no
2867 Arguments :
2868 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2869
2870 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2871 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2872 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2873 will catch all undetermined requests.
2874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002875 Example :
2876
2877 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2878 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2879 default_backend dynamic
2880
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002881 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002882
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002883
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002884description <string>
2885 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2887 no | yes | yes | yes
2888 Arguments : string
2889
2890 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2891 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2892 it describes.
2893 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2894
2895
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002896disabled
2897 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2899 yes | yes | yes | yes
2900 Arguments : none
2901
2902 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2903 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2904 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2905 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2906 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2907 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2908 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2909
2910 See also : "enabled"
2911
2912
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002913dispatch <address>:<port>
2914 Set a default server address
2915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2916 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002917 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002918
2919 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2920 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2921 during start-up.
2922
2923 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2924 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2925 possible with normal servers.
2926
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002927 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002928 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2929 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2930 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2931 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2932
2933 See also : "server"
2934
2935
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002936enabled
2937 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 yes | yes | yes | yes
2940 Arguments : none
2941
2942 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2943 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2944
2945 See also : "disabled"
2946
2947
2948errorfile <code> <file>
2949 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2951 yes | yes | yes | yes
2952 Arguments :
2953 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04002954 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
2955 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002956
2957 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002958 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002959 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002960 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2961 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
2963 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2964 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2965 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2966
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002967 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2968
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002969 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2970 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2971 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2972 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2973
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002974 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2975 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2976 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2977 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2978 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2979 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2980
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002981 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2982 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2983 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002984 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002985 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2986
2987 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2988
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002989 Example :
2990 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01002991 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002992 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2993 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2994
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002995
2996errorloc <code> <url>
2997errorloc302 <code> <url>
2998 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | yes
3001 Arguments :
3002 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003003 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003004
3005 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3006 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3007 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3008 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3009 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3010
3011 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3012 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3013 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3014
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003015 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3016
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003017 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3018 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3019 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3020 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003021 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003022 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3023 request.
3024
3025 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3026
3027
3028errorloc303 <code> <url>
3029 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3031 yes | yes | yes | yes
3032 Arguments :
3033 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3034 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3035
3036 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3037 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3038 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3039 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3040 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3041
3042 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3043 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3044 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3045
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003046 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3047
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003048 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3049 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3050 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3051 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003052 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003053
3054 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3055
3056
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003057email-alert from <emailaddr>
3058 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3059 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3060 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3061 yes | yes | yes | yes
3062
3063 Arguments :
3064
3065 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3066
3067 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3068 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3069
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003070 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003071 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3072 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003073
3074
3075email-alert level <level>
3076 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3077 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3078 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3079 yes | yes | yes | yes
3080
3081 Arguments :
3082
3083 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3084 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3085 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3086
3087 By default level is alert
3088
3089 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3090 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3091 for the proxy.
3092
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003093 Alerts are sent when :
3094
3095 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3096 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3097 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3098 is notice or lower
3099 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3100 and a health check status update occurs
3101
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003102 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3103 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003104 section 3.6 about mailers.
3105
3106
3107email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3108 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3109 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3110 yes | yes | yes | yes
3111
3112 Arguments :
3113
3114 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3115
3116 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3117 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3118
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003119 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3120 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003121
3122
3123email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3124 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3125 mailers.
3126 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3127 yes | yes | yes | yes
3128
3129 Arguments :
3130
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003131 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003132
3133 By default the systems hostname is used.
3134
3135 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3136 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3137 for the proxy.
3138
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003139 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3140 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003141
3142
3143email-alert to <emailaddr>
3144 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3145 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3146 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | yes | yes | yes
3148
3149 Arguments :
3150
3151 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3152
3153 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3154 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3155
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003156 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003157 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3158
3159
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003160force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3161 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3162 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3163 no | yes | yes | yes
3164
3165 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3166 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3167 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3168 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3169 marked down for maintenance operations.
3170
3171 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3172 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3173 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3174 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3175 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3176 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3177 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3178 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3179 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3180
3181 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3182 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3183 is used.
3184
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003185 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003186 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003187
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003188
3189filter <name> [param*]
3190 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3192 no | yes | yes | yes
3193 Arguments :
3194 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3195 referenced in section 9.
3196
3197 <param*> is a list of parameters accpeted by the filter <name>. The
3198 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
3199 filter. Please refer to the documention of the corresponding
3200 filter (section 9) from all details on the supported parameters.
3201
3202 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3203 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3204
3205 Example:
3206 listen
3207 bind *:80
3208
3209 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3210 filter compression
3211 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3212
3213 compression algo gzip
3214 compression offload
3215
3216 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3217
3218 See also : section 9.
3219
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003220
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003221fullconn <conns>
3222 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3224 yes | no | yes | yes
3225 Arguments :
3226 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3227 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3228
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003229 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003230 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003231 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003232 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3233 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3234 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3235 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3236 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003237 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003238
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003239 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3240 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003241 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3242 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3243 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003244
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003245 Example :
3246 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3247 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3248 # connections.
3249 backend dynamic
3250 fullconn 10000
3251 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3252 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3253
3254 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3255
3256
3257grace <time>
3258 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003260 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003261 Arguments :
3262 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3263 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3264 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3265
3266 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3267 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003268 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003269 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3270
3271 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3272 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3273 simplify it.
3274
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003275
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003276hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003277 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3279 yes | no | yes | yes
3280 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003281 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3282 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003283
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003284 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3285 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3286 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3287 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3288 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3289 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3290 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3291 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3292 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3293 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003294
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003295 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3296 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3297 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3298 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3299 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3300 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3301 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3302 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3303 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3304 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3305 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3306 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3307 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003308 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3309 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003310
3311 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3312
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003313 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003314 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3315 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3316 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003317 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3318 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3319 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003320
3321 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3322 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003323 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3324 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3325 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3326 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3327
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003328 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3329 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3330 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3331 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3332 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3333 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3334 parameter.
3335
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003336 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3337 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3338 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3339 used on strings.
3340
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003341 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3342
3343 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3344 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3345 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3346 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3347 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3348 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3349 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3350 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3351 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3352 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3353 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3354 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003355
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003356 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3357 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3358 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003359
3360 See also : "balance", "server"
3361
3362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003363http-check disable-on-404
3364 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003366 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003367 Arguments : none
3368
3369 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3370 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3371 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3372 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3373 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3374 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3375 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3376 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003377 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3378 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3379 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3380
3381 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3382
3383
3384http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003385 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003387 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003388 Arguments :
3389 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3390 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003391 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003392 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3393 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3394 details on the supported keywords.
3395
3396 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3397 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3398 with the usual backslash ('\').
3399
3400 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3401 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3402 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3403 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3404 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3405
3406 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003407 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003408 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3409 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3410 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3411
3412 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003413 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003414 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3415 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3416 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3417 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3418
3419 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003420 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003421 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3422 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3423 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3424 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3425 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3426 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3427 trace).
3428
3429 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003430 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003431 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3432 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3433 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3434 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3435 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3436 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3437
3438 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3439 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3440 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3441 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3442 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3443 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3444 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3445 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3446
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003447 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3448 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3449 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3450
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003451 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3452 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3453
3454 Examples :
3455 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003456 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003457
3458 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003459 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003460
3461 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003462 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003463
3464 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003465 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003467 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003468
3469
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003470http-check send-state
3471 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3472 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3473 yes | no | yes | yes
3474 Arguments : none
3475
3476 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3477 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3478 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3479 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3480 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3481
3482 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3483 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3484 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3485 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3486 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003487 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3488 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3489 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3490
3491 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3492 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3493 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3494
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003495 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3496 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3497 checked in multiple backends.
3498
3499 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3500 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3501
3502 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3503 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3504 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3505 one fails.
3506
3507 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3508 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3509 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3510
3511 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3512 server's queue.
3513
3514 Example of a header received by the application server :
3515 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3516 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3517
3518 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3519
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003520http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3521 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003522 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003523 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003524 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003525 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3526 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003527 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3528 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003529 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3530 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3531 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003532 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003533 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003534 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003535 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003536 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003537 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003538 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003539 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003540 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3541
3542 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3543 no | yes | yes | yes
3544
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003545 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3546 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3547 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3548 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3549 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003550
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003551 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3552 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3553 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3554
3555 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003556 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3557 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3558 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3559 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003560
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003561 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3562 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3563 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3564 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3565 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3566 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3567 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3568 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3569 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003570 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003571 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3572 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003573
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003574 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3575 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3576 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3577 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3578 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3579
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003580 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3581 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3582 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003583 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3584 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003585
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003586 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3587 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3588 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3589 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3590 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3591 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3592 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3593 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3594
3595 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3596 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3597 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003598 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3599 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003600
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003601 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3602 <name>.
3603
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003604 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3605 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3606 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3607 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3608 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3609 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3610 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3611 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3612
3613 Example:
3614
3615 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3616
3617 applied to:
3618
3619 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3620
3621 outputs:
3622
3623 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3624
3625 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3626
3627 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3628 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3629 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3630 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3631 header.
3632
3633 Example:
3634
3635 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3636
3637 applied to:
3638
3639 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3640
3641 outputs:
3642
3643 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3644
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003645 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3646 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3647 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3648 it.
3649
3650 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3651 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3652 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3653 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3654 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3655 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3656
3657 Example :
3658 # prepend the host name before the path
3659 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3660
3661 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3662 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3663 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3664 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3665 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3666 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3667 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3668 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3669
3670 Example :
3671 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3672 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3673
3674 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3675 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3676 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3677 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3678 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3679 "set-query".
3680
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003681 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3682 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3683 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3684 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3685 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3686 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3687 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3688 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3689
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003690 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3691 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3692 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3693 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3694 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3695 another equipment.
3696
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003697 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3698 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3699 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3700 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3701 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3702 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3703 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3704 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3705
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003706 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3707 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3708 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3709 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3710 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3711 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3712 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3713 admin privileges.
3714
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003715 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3716 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3717 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3718 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3719 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3720 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3721 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3722 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3723
3724 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3725 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3726 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3727 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3728 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3729 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3730
3731 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3732 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3733 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3734 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3735 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3736 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3737
3738 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3739 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3740 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3741 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3742 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3743 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3744 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3745 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3746 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3747
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003748 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003749 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3750 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3751 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3752 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3753 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3754 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3755 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3756 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3757 request header" for more information.
3758
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003759 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3760 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3761 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3762 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003763 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3764 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003765
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003766 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3767 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3768 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3769 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3770 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3771 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3772 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3773 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3774 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3775 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3776 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3777 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3778
3779 These actions take one or two arguments :
3780 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3781 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3782 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3783 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3784
3785 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3786 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3787 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3788 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3789
3790 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3791 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3792 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3793 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3794 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3795 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3796 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3797 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3798
3799 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3800 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3801 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3802 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3803 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3804
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003805 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3806 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3807 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3808 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3809 continues.
3810
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003811 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3812 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3813 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3814 the actions evaluation continues.
3815
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003816 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3817 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3818 inline.
3819
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003820 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3821 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
3822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003824 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003826 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003827 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3828 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003829 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003830 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003831 and '_'.
3832
3833 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3834 followed by some converters.
3835
3836 Example:
3837
3838 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3839
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003840 - set-src <expr> :
3841 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3842 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3843 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3844 source IP for privacy.
3845
3846 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3847 followed by some converters.
3848
3849 Example:
3850
3851 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3852 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3853
3854 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
3855
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02003856 - set-src-port <expr> :
3857 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
3858 expression.
3859
3860 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3861 followed by some converters.
3862
3863 Example:
3864
3865 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
3866 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
3867
3868 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
3869 the source port to 0.
3870
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02003871 - set-dst <expr> :
3872 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
3873 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
3874 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3875 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3876 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3877
3878 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3879 followed by some converters.
3880
3881 Example:
3882
3883 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
3884 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
3885
3886 - set-dst-port <expr> :
3887 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
3888 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
3889 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
3890
3891 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3892 followed by some converters.
3893
3894 Example:
3895
3896 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
3897 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
3898
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003899 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
3900 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
3901 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
3902 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
3903 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
3904 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
3905 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
3906 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
3907 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
3908 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
3909 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
3910 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
3911 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
3912 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
3913 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
3914 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
3915
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003916 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3917
3918 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3919 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08003920 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
3921 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
3922
3923 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
3924 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
3925 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
3926 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003927
3928 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003929 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3930 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3931 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003932
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003933 http-request allow if nagios
3934 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3935 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3936 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003937
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003938 Example:
3939 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003940 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003941
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003942 Example:
3943 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3944 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02003945 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003946 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3947 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3948 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3949 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3950 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3951 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3952
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003953 Example:
3954 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3955 acl add path /addacl
3956 acl del path /delacl
3957
3958 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3959
3960 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3961 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3962
3963 Example:
3964 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3965 acl setmap path /setmap
3966 acl delmap path /delmap
3967
3968 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3969
3970 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3971 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3972
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003973 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3974 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003975
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003976http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02003977 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003978 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003979 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
3980 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02003981 set-status <status> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003982 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3983 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3984 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3985 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003986 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003987 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08003988 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003989 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003990 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003991 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003992 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003993 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003994 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3995
3996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3997 no | yes | yes | yes
3998
3999 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4000 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4001 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4002 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4003 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4004 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4005
4006 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4007 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4008 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4009 current section.
4010
4011 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4012 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4013 rules are evaluated.
4014
4015 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4016 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4017 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4018 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4019 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4020 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4021 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4022
4023 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4024 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4025 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4026 external users.
4027
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004028 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4029 <name>.
4030
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004031 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4032 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4033 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4034 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4035 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4036 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4037 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4038 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4039
4040 Example:
4041
4042 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4043
4044 applied to:
4045
4046 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4047
4048 outputs:
4049
4050 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4051
4052 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4053
4054 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4055 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4056 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4057 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4058 header.
4059
4060 Example:
4061
4062 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4063
4064 applied to:
4065
4066 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4067
4068 outputs:
4069
4070 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4071
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004072 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
4073 be an integer between 100 and 999. Note that the reason is automatically
4074 adapted to the new code.
4075
4076 Example:
4077
4078 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4079 http-response set-status 431
4080
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004081 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4082 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4083 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4084 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4085 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4086 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4087 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4088 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4089
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004090 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4091 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4092 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4093 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4094 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4095 another equipment.
4096
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004097 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4098 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4099 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4100 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4101 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4102 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4103 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4104 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4105
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004106 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4107 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4108 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4109 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4110 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4111 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4112 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4113 admin privileges.
4114
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004115 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4116 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4117 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4118 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4119 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4120 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4121 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4122 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4123
4124 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4125 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4126 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4127 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4128 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4129 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4130
4131 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4132 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4133 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4134 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4135 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4136 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4137
4138 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4139 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4140 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4141 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4142 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4143 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4144 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4145 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4146 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4147
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004148 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4149 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4150 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4151 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4152 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4153 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4154 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4155 response header" for more information.
4156
4157 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4158 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4159 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4160 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4161 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004162 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4163 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004164
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004165 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4166 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4167 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4168 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4169 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4170 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4171
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004172 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4173 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4174 inline.
4175
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004176 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4177 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
4178 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4179 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004180 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004181 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004182 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004183 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4184 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004185 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004186 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004187 and '_'.
4188
4189 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4190 followed by some converters.
4191
4192 Example:
4193
4194 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4195
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004196 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4197 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4198 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4199 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4200 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4201 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4202 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4203
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004204 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4205 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4206 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4207 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4208 continues.
4209
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004210 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4211 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4212 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4213 the actions evaluation continues.
4214
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004215 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4216 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4217 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4218 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4219 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4220 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4221 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4222 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4223 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4224 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4225 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4226 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4227 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4228 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4229 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4230 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4231
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004232 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4233
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004234 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004235 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4236 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004237 rules.
4238
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004239 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4240 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4241 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4242 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4243
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004244 Example:
4245 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4246
4247 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4248
4249 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4250 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4251
4252 Example:
4253 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4254
4255 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4256
4257 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4258 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4259
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004260 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4261 ACL usage.
4262
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004263
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004264http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4265 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4266
4267 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4268 yes | no | yes | yes
4269
4270 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4271 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4272 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4273 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4274 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4275 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4276
4277 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4278
4279 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4280 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4281 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4282 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4283 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4284 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4285 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4286 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4287 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4288 not checking any request past the first one.
4289
4290 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4291 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4292 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4293 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4294 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4295 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4296 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4297
4298 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4299 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4300 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4301 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4302 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4303 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4304 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4305 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4306 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4307 downsides of rare connection failures.
4308
4309 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4310 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4311 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4312 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4313 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4314 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4315 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4316 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4317 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4318 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4319 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4320 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4321
4322 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4323 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4324 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4325 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4326
4327 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4328 and are never shared ;
4329
4330 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4331 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4332 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4333 and are never shared ;
4334
4335 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4336 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4337 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4338
4339 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4340 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4341 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4342
4343 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4344
4345
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004346http-send-name-header [<header>]
4347 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4348
4349 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4350 yes | no | yes | yes
4351
4352 Arguments :
4353
4354 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4355
4356 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4357 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4358 is added with the header string proved.
4359
4360 See also : "server"
4361
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004362id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004363 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4365 no | yes | yes | yes
4366 Arguments : none
4367
4368 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4369 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4370 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004371
4372
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004373ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4374 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4376 no | yes | yes | yes
4377
4378 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4379 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4380 and running).
4381
4382 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4383 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4384 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004385 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004386 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4387
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004388 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4389 "unless" condition is met.
4390
4391 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4392
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004393load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4394 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4395 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4396 yes | no | yes | yes
4397
4398 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4399 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4400 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4401 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4402 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4403 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4404 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4405 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4406
4407 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4408 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004409 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004410
4411 Arguments:
4412 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4413 named "server-state-file".
4414
4415 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4416 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4417 name is used as a file name.
4418
4419 none don't load any stat for this backend
4420
4421 Notes:
4422 - server's IP address is not updated unless DNS resolution is enabled on
4423 the server. It means that if a server IP address has been changed using
4424 the stat socket, this information won't be re-applied after reloading.
4425
4426 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4427 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4428
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004429 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004430
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004431 global
4432 stats socket /tmp/socket
4433 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004434
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004435 defaults
4436 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004437
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004438 backend bk
4439 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4440 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004441
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004442
4443 Then one can run :
4444
4445 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4446
4447 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4448
4449 1
4450 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4451 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4452 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4453
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004454 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004455
4456 global
4457 stats socket /tmp/socket
4458 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4459
4460 defaults
4461 load-server-state-from-file local
4462
4463 backend bk
4464 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4465 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4466
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004467
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004468 Then one can run :
4469
4470 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4471
4472 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4473
4474 1
4475 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4476 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4477 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4478
4479 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4480 "show servers state"
4481
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004482
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004483log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004484log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004485no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004486 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4488 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004489
4490 Prefix :
4491 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4492 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4493 prefix does not allow arguments.
4494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004495 Arguments :
4496 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4497 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4498 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4499 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4500 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4501 parameter.
4502
4503 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4504 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4505
4506 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4507 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4508 standard syslog port).
4509
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004510 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4511 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4512 standard syslog port).
4513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004514 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4515 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4516 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4517 appropriately writeable).
4518
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004519 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4520 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004521
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004522 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4523 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4524 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4525 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4526 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4527 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4528 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4529 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4530 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4531 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4532 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4533
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004534 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4535
4536 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4537 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4538 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4539
4540 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4541 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4542 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004543 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4544 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4545 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4546 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4547 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004548
4549 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4550
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004551 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4552 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4553 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004554
4555 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4556 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4557 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4558 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4559
4560 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4561 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004562
4563 Example :
4564 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004565 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4566 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004567 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004568
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004569
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004570log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004571 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4573 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004574
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004575 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4576 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4577 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4578 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4579 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004580
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004581log-format-sd <string>
4582 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4583 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4584 yes | yes | yes | no
4585
4586 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4587 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4588 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4589 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4590 which covers the log format string in depth.
4591
4592 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4593 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4594
4595 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4596 log format to "rfc5424".
4597
4598 Example :
4599 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4600
4601
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004602log-tag <string>
4603 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4604 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4605 yes | yes | yes | yes
4606
4607 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4608 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4609 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4610 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4611 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4612 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4613 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4614 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4615 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004616
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004617max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4618 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4619 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | no | yes | yes
4621
4622 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4623 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4624 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4625 servers.
4626
4627 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4628 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4629 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4630 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4631 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4632 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4633 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4634 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4635 picking a different server.
4636
4637 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4638 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4639 even if they have to be queued.
4640
4641 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4642 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4643
4644
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004645maxconn <conns>
4646 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4648 yes | yes | yes | no
4649 Arguments :
4650 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4651 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4652 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4653 closes.
4654
4655 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4656 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4657 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4658 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004659 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4660 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4661 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4662 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004663
4664 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4665 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4666 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4667
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004668 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4669
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004670 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4671
4672
4673mode { tcp|http|health }
4674 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 yes | yes | yes | yes
4677 Arguments :
4678 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4679 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4680 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4681 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4682
4683 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4684 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4685 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4686 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4687 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4688
4689 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004690 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4691 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4692 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4693 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4694 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4695 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4696 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004697
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004698 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4699 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4700 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004702 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004703 defaults http_instances
4704 mode http
4705
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004706 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004708
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004709monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004710 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4712 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004713 Arguments :
4714 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4715 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004716 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004717 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4718 backend and its backup.
4719
4720 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4721 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4722 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4723 servers in a list of backends.
4724
4725 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4726 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4727 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4728 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4729 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4730 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4731 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004732 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4733 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004734
4735 Example:
4736 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4739 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4740 monitor-uri /site_alive
4741 monitor fail if site_dead
4742
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004743 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004744
4745
4746monitor-net <source>
4747 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | yes | yes | no
4750 Arguments :
4751 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4752 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4753 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4754 followed by a mask.
4755
4756 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4757 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004758 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004759 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4760
4761 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4762 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4763 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4764 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004765 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4766 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4767 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004769 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4770 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4771 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4772 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4773 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4774 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004776 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4777 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004778
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004779 Example :
4780 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4781 frontend www
4782 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4783
4784 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4785
4786
4787monitor-uri <uri>
4788 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4790 yes | yes | yes | no
4791 Arguments :
4792 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4793 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4794
4795 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4796 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4797 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4798 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4799 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4800 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4801 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4802 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4803
4804 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4805 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4806 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4807 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4808 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4809 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4810
4811 Example :
4812 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4813 frontend www
4814 mode http
4815 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4816
4817 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004819
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004820option abortonclose
4821no option abortonclose
4822 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4824 yes | no | yes | yes
4825 Arguments : none
4826
4827 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4828 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4829 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4830 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004831 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004832 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
4833 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
4834 encountered while delivering the response.
4835
4836 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
4837 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
4838 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
4839 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
4840 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
4841 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004842 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004843 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004844 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004845 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
4846 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
4847 still not served and not pollute the servers.
4848
4849 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
4850 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
4851 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
4852 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
4853 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
4854 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
4855 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
4856 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004857 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004858
4859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4861
4862 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
4863
4864
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004865option accept-invalid-http-request
4866no option accept-invalid-http-request
4867 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
4868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4869 yes | yes | yes | no
4870 Arguments : none
4871
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004872 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004873 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4874 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4875 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4876 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4877 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4878 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4879 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004880 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
4881 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
4882 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
4883 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
4884 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004885 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02004886 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
4887 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
4888 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004889
4890 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4891 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4892 been confirmed.
4893
4894 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4895 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01004896 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
4897 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004898 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4899
4900 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4901 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4902
4903 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
4904 stats socket.
4905
4906
4907option accept-invalid-http-response
4908no option accept-invalid-http-response
4909 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
4910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4911 yes | no | yes | yes
4912 Arguments : none
4913
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004914 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004915 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
4916 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
4917 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
4918 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
4919 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
4920 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
4921 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02004922 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
4923 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
4924 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02004925
4926 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
4927 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
4928 been confirmed.
4929
4930 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
4931 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
4932 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
4933 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
4934
4935 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4936 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4937
4938 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
4939 stats socket.
4940
4941
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004942option allbackups
4943no option allbackups
4944 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
4945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | no | yes | yes
4947 Arguments : none
4948
4949 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
4950 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
4951 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
4952 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
4953 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
4954 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
4955 order between the backup servers anymore.
4956
4957 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
4958 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
4959
4960 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4961 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4962
4963
4964option checkcache
4965no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08004966 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4968 yes | no | yes | yes
4969 Arguments : none
4970
4971 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
4972 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004973 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004974 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
4975 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02004976 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004977
4978 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004979 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004980 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004981 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
4982 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004983 to the client are :
4984 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004985 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004986 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004987 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
4988 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
4989 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
4990 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
4991 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
4992 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
4993 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
4994 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
4995 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
4996 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
4997 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
4998
4999 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005000 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005001 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005002 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005003 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5004
5005 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5006 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005007 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005008 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5009
5010 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5011 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5012
5013
5014option clitcpka
5015no option clitcpka
5016 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5018 yes | yes | yes | no
5019 Arguments : none
5020
5021 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5022 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5023 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5024 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5025
5026 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5027 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5028 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5029 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5030
5031 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5032 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5033 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5034 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5035 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5036
5037 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5038
5039 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5040 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5041 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5042
5043 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5044 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5045
5046 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5047
5048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005049option contstats
5050 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5052 yes | yes | yes | no
5053 Arguments : none
5054
5055 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5056 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5057 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5058 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
5059 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
5060 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
5061 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
5062
5063
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005064option dontlog-normal
5065no option dontlog-normal
5066 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5068 yes | yes | yes | no
5069 Arguments : none
5070
5071 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5072 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5073 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5074 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5075 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5076 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5077 logged.
5078
5079 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5080 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5081 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005084 logging.
5085
5086
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005087option dontlognull
5088no option dontlognull
5089 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5091 yes | yes | yes | no
5092 Arguments : none
5093
5094 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5095 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5096 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5097 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5098 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5099 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005100 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5101 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5102 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005103
5104 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5105 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5106 would not be logged.
5107
5108 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5109 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5110
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005111 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5112 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005113
5114
5115option forceclose
5116no option forceclose
5117 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005119 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005120 Arguments : none
5121
5122 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5123 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5124 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5125 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5126 global session times in the logs.
5127
5128 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005129 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005130 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005131
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005132 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5133 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5134 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5135
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005136 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5137 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005138
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5141
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005142 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005143
5144
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005145option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005146 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5148 yes | yes | yes | yes
5149 Arguments :
5150 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5151 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005152 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005153 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005154
5155 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5156 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5157 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5158 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5159 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5160 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5161 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005162 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5163 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5164 possible that the client has already brought one.
5165
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005166 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005167 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005168 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5169 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005170 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5171 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005172
5173 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5174 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5175 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5176 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5177 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5178 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5179 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5180
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005181 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5182 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5183 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5184 are under the control of the end-user.
5185
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005186 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005187 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5188 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005189 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5190 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5191 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005192
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005193 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005194 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5195 frontend www
5196 mode http
5197 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5198
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005199 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5200 backend www
5201 mode http
5202 option forwardfor header X-Client
5203
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005204 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005205 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005206
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005207
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005208option http-buffer-request
5209no option http-buffer-request
5210 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 yes | yes | yes | yes
5213 Arguments : none
5214
5215 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5216 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5217 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5218 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5219 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5220 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5221 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5222 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
5223 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbufferred transmissions between
5224 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5225 default.
5226
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005227 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005228
5229
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005230option http-ignore-probes
5231no option http-ignore-probes
5232 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5234 yes | yes | yes | no
5235 Arguments : none
5236
5237 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5238 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5239 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5240 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5241 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5242 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5243 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5244 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5245 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5246 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5247 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5248 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5249
5250 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5251 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5252 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5253 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5254 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5255 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5256 are often the only way to detect them.
5257
5258 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5259 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5260
5261 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5262
5263
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005264option http-keep-alive
5265no option http-keep-alive
5266 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5267 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5268 yes | yes | yes | yes
5269 Arguments : none
5270
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005271 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5272 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5273 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5274 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5275 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5276 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5277 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5278
5279 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5280 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005281 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5282 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5283 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5284 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5285 situations where this option may be useful :
5286
5287 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5288 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5289
5290 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5291 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5292
5293 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5294 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5295 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5296 request.
5297
5298 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5299 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005300 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5301 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5302 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005303
5304 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5305 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5306
5307 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5308 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5309 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5310 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5311 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5312 not set.
5313
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005314 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5315 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005316 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005317 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005318
5319 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005320 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5321 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005322
5323
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005324option http-no-delay
5325no option http-no-delay
5326 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | yes | yes | yes
5329 Arguments : none
5330
5331 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5332 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5333 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5334 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5335 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5336 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5337 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5338 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5339 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5340 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5341 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5342 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5343 affected.
5344
5345 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5346 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5347 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5348 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5349 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5350 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5351 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5352 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5353 latency environments.
5354
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005355 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5356
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005357
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005358option http-pretend-keepalive
5359no option http-pretend-keepalive
5360 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5362 yes | yes | yes | yes
5363 Arguments : none
5364
5365 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5366 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5367 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5368 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5369 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5370 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5371 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5372 consider the response complete.
5373
5374 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5375 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5376 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5377 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5378 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5379 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5380
5381 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5382 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5383 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5384 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5385 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5386 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5387 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5388
5389 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5390 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005391 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005392 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5393 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005394
5395 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5396 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5397
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005398 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5399 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005400
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005401
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005402option http-server-close
5403no option http-server-close
5404 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | yes | yes | yes
5407 Arguments : none
5408
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005409 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5410 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5411 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5412 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5413 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5414 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5415 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5416 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5417 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5418 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5419 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5420 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5421 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5422 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5423 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5424 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005425
5426 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5427 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5428 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5429 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005430 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5431 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005432
5433 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5434 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005435 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5436 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005437 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5438 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005439
5440 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5441 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5442
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005443 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005444 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5445 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005446
5447
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005448option http-tunnel
5449no option http-tunnel
5450 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5452 yes | yes | yes | yes
5453 Arguments : none
5454
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005455 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5456 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5457 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5458 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5459 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5460 "option http-tunnel".
5461
5462 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005463 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005464 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5465 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5466 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5467 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5468 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5469 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5470 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005471
5472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5474
5475 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5476 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5477 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5478
5479
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005480option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005481no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005482 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5484 yes | yes | yes | no
5485 Arguments : none
5486
5487 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5488 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5489 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5490 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5491 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5492 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5493 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5494
5495 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5496 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005497 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5498 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5499 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005500
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005501 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5502 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5503 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5504 front of an existing proxy.
5505
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005506 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5507
5508 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5509 http-server-close".
5510
5511
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005512option httpchk
5513option httpchk <uri>
5514option httpchk <method> <uri>
5515option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5516 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5518 yes | no | yes | yes
5519 Arguments :
5520 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5521 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5522 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5523 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5524 ones.
5525
5526 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5527 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5528 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5529
5530 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5531 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5532 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5533 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5534 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5535
5536 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5537 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5538 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5539 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5540 the lack of any response.
5541
5542 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5543
5544 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5545 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5546 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5547
5548 Examples :
5549 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5550 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5551 backend https_relay
5552 mode tcp
5553 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5554 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5555
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005556 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5557 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5558 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005559
5560
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005561option httpclose
5562no option httpclose
5563 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5565 yes | yes | yes | yes
5566 Arguments : none
5567
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005568 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5569 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5570 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5571 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005572 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005573 "option http-tunnel".
5574
5575 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5576 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5577 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5578 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5579 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5580 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5581 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5582 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005583
5584 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005585 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005586 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5587 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5588 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5589 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5590 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005591
5592 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5593 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005594 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5595 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005596 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5597 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005598
5599 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5600 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5601
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005602 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5603 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005604
5605
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005606option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005607 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5609 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005610 Arguments :
5611 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5612 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5613 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5614 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5615 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005616
5617 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5618 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5619 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5620 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5621 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5622 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5623 ports.
5624
5625 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5626
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005627 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5628 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005629
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005630 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005631
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005632
5633option http_proxy
5634no option http_proxy
5635 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5637 yes | yes | yes | yes
5638 Arguments : none
5639
5640 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5641 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5642 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5643 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5644 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5645
5646 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5647 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005648 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5649 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005650
5651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5653
5654 Example :
5655 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5656 backend direct_forward
5657 option httpclose
5658 option http_proxy
5659
5660 See also : "option httpclose"
5661
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005662
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005663option independent-streams
5664no option independent-streams
5665 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 yes | yes | yes | yes
5668 Arguments : none
5669
5670 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5671 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5672 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5673 receive data or not.
5674
5675 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5676 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5677 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5678 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5679 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5680 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5681 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5682 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5683 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5684 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5685 socket buffers.
5686
5687 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5688 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5689 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5690 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5691 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5692
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005693 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005694 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5695 deprecated.
5696
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005697 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005698
5699
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005700option ldap-check
5701 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5703 yes | no | yes | yes
5704 Arguments : none
5705
5706 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5707 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5708 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5709 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5710
5711 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5712 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5713
5714 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5715 configure it.
5716
5717 Example :
5718 option ldap-check
5719
5720 See also : "option httpchk"
5721
5722
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005723option external-check
5724 Use external processes for server health checks
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | no | yes | yes
5727
5728 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5729 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5730 command".
5731
5732 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5733
5734 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5735
5736
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005737option log-health-checks
5738no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005739 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005740 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5741 yes | no | yes | yes
5742 Arguments : none
5743
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005744 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5745 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5746 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005747
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005748 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5749 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5750 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5751 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5752 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5753
5754 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5755 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005756
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005757 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5758 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5759 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005760
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005761
5762option log-separate-errors
5763no option log-separate-errors
5764 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5766 yes | yes | yes | no
5767 Arguments : none
5768
5769 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5770 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5771 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5772 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5773 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5774 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5775 provides very important information.
5776
5777 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5778 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5779 error logs.
5780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005781 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005782 logging.
5783
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005784
5785option logasap
5786no option logasap
5787 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5788 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5789 yes | yes | yes | no
5790 Arguments : none
5791
5792 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5793 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5794 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5795 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5796 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5797 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5798 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005799 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005800 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5801 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5802
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005803 Examples :
5804 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5805 mode http
5806 option httplog
5807 option logasap
5808 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5809
5810 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5811 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5812 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5813 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5814
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005815 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005816 logging.
5817
5818
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005819option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005820 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5822 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005823 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005824 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5825 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005826 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005827
5828 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5829 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5830 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
5831 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
5832 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
5833 in the MySQL table, like this :
5834
5835 USE mysql;
5836 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
5837 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
5838
5839 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
5840 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
5841 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
5842 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
5843 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
5844 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
5845 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
5846 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
5847 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
5848
5849 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
5850 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005851
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02005852 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005853
5854 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
5855 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
5856 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
5857 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02005858 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
5859 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005860
5861 See also: "option httpchk"
5862
5863
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005864option nolinger
5865no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005866 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005867 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5868 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005869 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005870
5871 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
5872 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
5873 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
5874 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
5875 connections.
5876
5877 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
5878 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
5879 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
5880 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
5881 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
5882 this too.
5883
5884 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
5885 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
5886 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
5887
5888 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
5889 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
5890 for servers.
5891
5892 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5893 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5894
5895
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005896option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
5897 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | yes | yes | yes
5900 Arguments :
5901 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5902 matching <network>
5903 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
5904 header name.
5905
5906 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
5907 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
5908 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
5909 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
5910 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
5911 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
5912 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
5913 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
5914 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5915 possible that the client has already brought one.
5916
5917 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
5918 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
5919 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
5920 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
5921 header and requires different one.
5922
5923 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5924 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5925 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5926 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5927 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5928 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5929 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5930
5931 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
5932 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5933 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
5934 both are defined.
5935
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005936 Examples :
5937 # Original Destination address
5938 frontend www
5939 mode http
5940 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
5941
5942 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
5943 backend www
5944 mode http
5945 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
5946
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005947 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
5948 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005949
5950
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005951option persist
5952no option persist
5953 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
5954 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5955 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005956 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005957
5958 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
5959 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
5960 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
5961 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
5962 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
5963 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
5964 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
5965 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
5966 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
5967 redirected to another valid server.
5968
5969 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5970 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5971
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005972 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01005973
5974
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01005975option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
5976 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
5977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5978 yes | no | yes | yes
5979 Arguments :
5980 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
5981 PostgreSQL server.
5982
5983 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
5984 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
5985 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
5986 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
5987
5988 See also: "option httpchk"
5989
5990
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005991option prefer-last-server
5992no option prefer-last-server
5993 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
5994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5995 yes | no | yes | yes
5996 Arguments : none
5997
5998 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
5999 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6000 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6001 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6002 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6003 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6004 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6005 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6006 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006007 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6008 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6009 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6010 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6011 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6012 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6013 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006014
6015 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6016 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6017
6018 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6019
6020
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006021option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006022option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006023no option redispatch
6024 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6026 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006027 Arguments :
6028 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6029 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6030 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6031 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6032 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6033 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6034 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6035 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6036 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6037
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006038
6039 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6040 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6041 be able to access the service anymore.
6042
6043 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6044 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6045
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006046 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006047 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6048 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006050 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6051 "redisp" keywords.
6052
6053 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6054 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6055
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006056 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006057
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006058
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006059option redis-check
6060 Use redis health checks for server testing
6061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6062 yes | no | yes | yes
6063 Arguments : none
6064
6065 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6066 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6067 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6068 find the "+PONG" response message.
6069
6070 Example :
6071 option redis-check
6072
6073 See also : "option httpchk"
6074
6075
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006076option smtpchk
6077option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6078 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6080 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006082 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6083 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6084 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6085
6086 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6087 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6088 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6089
6090 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6091 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6092 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6093 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6094 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6095 dead server.
6096
6097 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6098 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6099 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6100 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6101
6102 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6103 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6104 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6105 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006106 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006107
6108 Example :
6109 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6110
6111 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6112
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006114option socket-stats
6115no option socket-stats
6116
6117 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6119 yes | yes | yes | no
6120
6121 Arguments : none
6122
6123
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006124option splice-auto
6125no option splice-auto
6126 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6128 yes | yes | yes | yes
6129 Arguments : none
6130
6131 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6132 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6133 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6134 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006135 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006136 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6137 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6138 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6139 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6140
6141 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6142 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6143 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6144 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6145 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6146 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6147 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6148 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6149 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6150 keyword.
6151
6152 Example :
6153 option splice-auto
6154
6155 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6156 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6157
6158 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6159 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6160
6161
6162option splice-request
6163no option splice-request
6164 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 yes | yes | yes | yes
6167 Arguments : none
6168
6169 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006170 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006171 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6172 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6173 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6174 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6175
6176 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6177
6178 Example :
6179 option splice-request
6180
6181 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6182 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6183
6184 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6185 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6186
6187
6188option splice-response
6189no option splice-response
6190 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6192 yes | yes | yes | yes
6193 Arguments : none
6194
6195 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006196 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006197 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6198 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6199 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6200 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6201
6202 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6203
6204 Example :
6205 option splice-response
6206
6207 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6208 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6209
6210 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6211 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6212
6213
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006214option srvtcpka
6215no option srvtcpka
6216 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6218 yes | no | yes | yes
6219 Arguments : none
6220
6221 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6222 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6223 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6224 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6225
6226 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6227 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6228 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6229 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6230
6231 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6232 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6233 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6234 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6235 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6236
6237 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6238
6239 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6240 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6241 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6242
6243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6245
6246 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6247
6248
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006249option ssl-hello-chk
6250 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6252 yes | no | yes | yes
6253 Arguments : none
6254
6255 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6256 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6257 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6258 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6259 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6260 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6261 hello message.
6262
6263 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6264 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6265 messages, which is appreciable.
6266
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006267 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6268 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6269 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006270
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006271 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6272
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006273
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006274option tcp-check
6275 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6276 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6277 yes | no | yes | yes
6278
6279 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6280 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6281
6282 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6283 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6284 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6285
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006286 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006287 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6288 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6289 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6290 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6291 only.
6292
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006293 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006294 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6295 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6296 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6297 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6298
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006299 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006300 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6301 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006302 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006303 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6304 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6305 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6306 the respective protocols.
6307 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6308 analysed.
6309
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006310 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6311 script.
6312
6313 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6314 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6315 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6316 The "comment" is of course optional.
6317
6318
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006319 Examples :
6320 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6321 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006322 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006323
6324 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6325 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006326 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006327
6328 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6329 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006330 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006331 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006332 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006333 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006334 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006335 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006336 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6337 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006338 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006339 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6340 tcp-check expect string +OK
6341
6342 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6343 (send many headers before analyzing)
6344 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006345 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006346 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6347 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6348 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6349 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006350 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006351
6352
6353 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6354
6355
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006356option tcp-smart-accept
6357no option tcp-smart-accept
6358 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6360 yes | yes | yes | no
6361 Arguments : none
6362
6363 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6364 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6365 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6366 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6367 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6368 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6369
6370 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6371 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6372 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6373 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6374
6375 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6376 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6377 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6378 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6379
6380 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6381 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6382 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6383
6384 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6385 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6386 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6387
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006388 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6389
6390
6391option tcp-smart-connect
6392no option tcp-smart-connect
6393 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6395 yes | no | yes | yes
6396 Arguments : none
6397
6398 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6399 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6400 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6401 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6402 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6403
6404 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6405 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6406 complex.
6407
6408 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6409 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6410 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6411
6412 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6413 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6414
6415 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6416
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006417
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006418option tcpka
6419 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6421 yes | yes | yes | yes
6422 Arguments : none
6423
6424 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6425 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6426 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6427 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6428
6429 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6430 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6431 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6432 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6433
6434 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6435 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6436 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6437 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6438 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6439
6440 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6441
6442 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6443 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6444 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6445 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6446 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6447 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6448 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6449 backends.
6450
6451 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6452
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006453
6454option tcplog
6455 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6457 yes | yes | yes | yes
6458 Arguments : none
6459
6460 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6461 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6462 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6463 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6464 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6465 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6466 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6467 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6468
6469 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006471 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006472
6473
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006474option transparent
6475no option transparent
6476 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006478 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006479 Arguments : none
6480
6481 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6482 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6483 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6484 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6485 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6486 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6487 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6488 appropriate server.
6489
6490 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6491 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6492
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006493 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006494 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006495
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006496
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006497external-check command <command>
6498 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6499 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6500 yes | no | yes | yes
6501
6502 Arguments :
6503 <command> is the external command to run
6504
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006505 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6506
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006507 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006508
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006509 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6510 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6511 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6512 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6513 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6514 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006515
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006516 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6517
6518 Environment variables :
6519 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6520 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6521
6522 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6523
6524 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6525
6526 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6527 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6528 for a UNIX socket).
6529
6530 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6531
6532 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6533
6534 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6535
6536 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6537
6538 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6539
6540 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6541 socket).
6542
6543 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6544 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6545
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006546 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6547 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6548 failed.
6549
6550 Example :
6551 external-check command /bin/true
6552
6553 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6554
6555
6556external-check path <path>
6557 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6559 yes | no | yes | yes
6560
6561 Arguments :
6562 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6563
6564 The default path is "".
6565
6566 Example :
6567 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6568
6569 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6570 "external-check command"
6571
6572
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006573persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006574persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006575 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6577 yes | no | yes | yes
6578 Arguments :
6579 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006580 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6581 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006582
6583 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6584 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6585 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6586 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6587 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6588 forwarded to this server.
6589
6590 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6591 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6592 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006593 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006594 a single "listen" section.
6595
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006596 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6597 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6598 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6599
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006600 Example :
6601 listen tse-farm
6602 bind :3389
6603 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6604 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6605 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6606 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6607 persist rdp-cookie
6608 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006609 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006610 balance rdp-cookie
6611 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6612 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6613
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006614 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6615 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006616
6617
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006618rate-limit sessions <rate>
6619 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6621 yes | yes | yes | no
6622 Arguments :
6623 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6624 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6625
6626 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6627 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6628 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6629 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6630 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6631 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6632
6633 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6634 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6635 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6636 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6637
6638 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6639 listen smtp
6640 mode tcp
6641 bind :25
6642 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006643 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006644
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006645 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6646 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6647 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006648
6649 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6650
6651
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006652redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6653redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6654redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006655 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6657 no | yes | yes | yes
6658
6659 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006660 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006661
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006662 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006663 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006664 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6665 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6666 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006667
6668 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6669 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6670 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6671 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6672 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006673 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6674 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6675 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6676 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006677
6678 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6679 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6680 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6681 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6682 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6683 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006684 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006685 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006686 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6687 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6688 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006689
6690 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006691 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6692 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6693 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006694 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006695 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6696 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6697 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6698 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006699
6700 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6701 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6702
6703 - "drop-query"
6704 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6705 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6706 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6707 with a location-type redirect.
6708
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006709 - "append-slash"
6710 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6711 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6712 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6713 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6714
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006715 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6716 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6717 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6718 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6719 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6720 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6721 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6722
6723 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6724 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6725 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6726 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6727 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6728 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6729 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006730
6731 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6732 acl clear dst_port 80
6733 acl secure dst_port 8080
6734 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006735 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006736 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006737 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6738
6739 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006740 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6741 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6742 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006743 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006744
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006745 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6746 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6747 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6748
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006749 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006750 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006751
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006752 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006753 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6754 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6755 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006757 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006758
6759
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006760redisp (deprecated)
6761redispatch (deprecated)
6762 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6764 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006765 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006766
6767 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6768 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6769 be able to access the service anymore.
6770
6771 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6772 redistribute them to a working server.
6773
6774 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6775 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6776 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006777
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006778 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6779 "option redispatch" instead.
6780
6781 See also : "option redispatch"
6782
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006783
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006784reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006785 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6787 no | yes | yes | yes
6788 Arguments :
6789 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6790 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006791 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006792
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006793 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6794 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6795
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006796 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6797 the last header of an HTTP request.
6798
6799 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6800 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6801 responses.
6802
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006803 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6804 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6805 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6806
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006807 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6808 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006809
6810
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006811reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6812reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006813 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6815 no | yes | yes | yes
6816 Arguments :
6817 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6818 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6819 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6820 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6821 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6822 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
6823 ignores case.
6824
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006825 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6826 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6827
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006828 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6829 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
6830 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6831 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006832 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006833
6834 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6835 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6836
6837 Example :
6838 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
6839 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6840 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6841
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006842 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
6843 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006844
6845
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006846reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6847reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006848 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
6849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 no | yes | yes | yes
6851 Arguments :
6852 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6853 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6854 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6855 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6856 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
6857 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
6858
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006859 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6860 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6861
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006862 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
6863 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
6864 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
6865 next servers.
6866
6867 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6868 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6869 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
6870
6871 Example :
6872 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
6873 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
6874 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
6875
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006876 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
6877 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006878
6879
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006880reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6881reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006882 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
6883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6884 no | yes | yes | yes
6885 Arguments :
6886 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6887 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6888 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6889 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6890 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6891 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
6892 case.
6893
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006894 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6895 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6896
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006897 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6898 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
6899 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
6900 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006901 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006902
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006903 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006904 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006905 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01006906
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006907 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6908 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6909
6910 Example :
6911 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
6912 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6913 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6914
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006915 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6916 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006917
6918
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006919reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6920reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006921 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
6922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6923 no | yes | yes | yes
6924 Arguments :
6925 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6926 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6927 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6928 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6929 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
6930 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
6931 case.
6932
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006933 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6934 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6935
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006936 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
6937 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
6938 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
6939 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6940
6941 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
6942 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
6943
6944 Example :
6945 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
6946 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
6947 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
6948 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
6949
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006950 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
6951 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006952
6953
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006954reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6955reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006956 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
6957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6958 no | yes | yes | yes
6959 Arguments :
6960 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
6961 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
6962 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
6963 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
6964 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
6965 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
6966
6967 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6968 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
6969 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
6970 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006971 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006972
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006973 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6974 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6975
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006976 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
6977 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
6978 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
6979
6980 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6981 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6982 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
6983 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
6984 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
6985
6986 Example :
6987 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006988 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006989 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
6990 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
6991
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006992 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
6993 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006994
6995
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006996reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6997reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006998 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
6999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7000 no | yes | yes | yes
7001 Arguments :
7002 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7003 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7004 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7005 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7006 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7007 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7008 ignores case.
7009
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007010 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7011 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7012
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007013 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7014 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007015 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7016 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7017 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007018 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7019 not set.
7020
7021 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7022 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7023 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7024 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7025 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7026
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007027 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007028 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7029 # block all others.
7030 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7031 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7032
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007033 # block bad guys
7034 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7035 reqitarpit . if badguys
7036
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007037 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7038 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007039
7040
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007041retries <value>
7042 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7043 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7044 yes | no | yes | yes
7045 Arguments :
7046 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7047 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7048 default value is 3.
7049
7050 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7051 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7052 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7053
7054 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007055 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7056 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007057
7058 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7059 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7060
7061 See also : "option redispatch"
7062
7063
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007064rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007065 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7067 no | yes | yes | yes
7068 Arguments :
7069 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7070 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007071 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007072
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007073 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7074 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7075
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007076 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7077 the last header of an HTTP response.
7078
7079 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7080 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7081 responses.
7082
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007083 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7084 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007085
7086
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007087rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7088rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007089 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7090 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7091 no | yes | yes | yes
7092 Arguments :
7093 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7094 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7095 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7096 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7097 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7098 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7099 ignores case.
7100
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007101 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7102 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7103
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7105 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007106 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107 client.
7108
7109 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7110 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7111 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7112
7113 Example :
7114 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007115 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007116
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007117 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7118 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007119
7120
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007121rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7122rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007123 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7125 no | yes | yes | yes
7126 Arguments :
7127 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7128 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7129 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7130 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7131 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7132 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7133 ignores case.
7134
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007135 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7136 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7137
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007138 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7139 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7140 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7141 case-sensitive.
7142
7143 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007144 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7145 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7146 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007147
7148 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7149 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7150
7151 Example :
7152 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7153 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7154
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007155 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7156 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007157
7158
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007159rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7160rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007161 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7163 no | yes | yes | yes
7164 Arguments :
7165 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7166 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7167 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7168 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7169 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7170 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7171 ignores case.
7172
7173 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7174 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7175 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7176 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007177 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007178
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007179 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7180 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7181
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007182 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7183 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7184 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7185
7186 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7187 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7188 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7189 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7190 are not case-sensitive.
7191
7192 Example :
7193 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7194 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7195
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007196 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7197 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007198
7199
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007200server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007201 Declare a server in a backend
7202 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7203 no | no | yes | yes
7204 Arguments :
7205 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007206 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007207 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007208
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007209 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7210 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7211 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7212 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007213 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7214 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7215 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7216 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7217 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007218 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7219 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7220 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7221 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7222 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7223 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7224 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007225 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007226 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7227 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
7228 variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007230 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007231 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7232 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7233 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7234 adding this value to the client's port.
7235
7236 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7237 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007238 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007239
7240 Examples :
7241 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7242 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007243 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007244 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7245 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7246 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007247
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007248 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7249 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7250 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7251 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7252 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7253
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007254 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7255 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007256
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007257server-state-file-name [<file>]
7258 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7259 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7260 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7261 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7262 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7263 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7264
7265 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7266 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7267
7268 global
7269 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7270
7271 backend bk
7272 load-server-state-from-file
7273
7274 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7275 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007276
7277source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007278source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007279source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007280 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7282 yes | no | yes | yes
7283 Arguments :
7284 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7285 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007286
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007287 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007288 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7289 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7290 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7291 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7292 supported prefixes are :
7293 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7294 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7295 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007296 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007297 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7298 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007299
7300 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7301 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007302 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7303 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7304 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007305
7306 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7307 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7308 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7309 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7310 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7311 <addr>.
7312
7313 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7314 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7315 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7316 port.
7317
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007318 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7319 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7320 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7321 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007322 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007323 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7324 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7325 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7326 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7327 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7328 HTTP header.
7329
7330 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7331 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007332 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007333 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7334 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7335 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7336 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7337 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7338 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7339 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7340
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007341 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7342 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7343 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7344 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7345 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7346 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7347
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007348 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7349 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7350 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7351 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7352
7353 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7354 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7355 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7356 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7357 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7358 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7359
7360 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7361 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7362 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7363 there are two methods :
7364
7365 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7366 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7367 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7368 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7369 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7370 of the client ranges may be used.
7371
7372 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7373 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7374 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7375 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7376 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7377 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7378 same session.
7379
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007380 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7381 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7382 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007383 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007384
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007385 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7386
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007387 Examples :
7388 backend private
7389 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7390 source 192.168.1.200
7391
7392 backend transparent_ssl1
7393 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7394 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7395
7396 backend transparent_ssl2
7397 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7398 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7399 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7400
7401 backend transparent_ssl3
7402 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7403 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7404 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7405
7406 backend transparent_smtp
7407 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7408 # with Tproxy version 4.
7409 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7410
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007411 backend transparent_http
7412 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7413 # proxy.
7414 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7415
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007417 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7418
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007419
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007420srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7421 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7423 yes | no | yes | yes
7424 Arguments :
7425 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7426 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7427 as explained at the top of this document.
7428
7429 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7430 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7431 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7432 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7433 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7434 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7435 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7436
7437 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7438 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7439 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7440 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7441 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007442 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007443 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007444 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007445
7446 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7447 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7448 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7449 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7450 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7451 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7452
7453 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7454 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7455
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007456 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7457 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007458
7459
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007460stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7461 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007463 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007464
7465 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7466 matched.
7467
7468 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7469 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7470
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007471 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7472 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7473 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7474
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007475 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7476 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7477 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7478 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007479
7480 Example :
7481 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7482 backend stats_localhost
7483 stats enable
7484 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7485
7486 Example :
7487 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7488 backend stats_auth
7489 stats enable
7490 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7491 stats admin if TRUE
7492
7493 Example :
7494 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7495 userlist stats-auth
7496 group admin users admin
7497 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7498 group readonly users haproxy
7499 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7500
7501 backend stats_auth
7502 stats enable
7503 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7504 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7505 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7506 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7507
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007508 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7509 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7510 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007511
7512
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007513stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7514 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007516 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007517 Arguments :
7518 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7519
7520 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7521
7522 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7523 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7524 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7525 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7526 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7527 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7528
7529 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7530 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7531 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007532 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007533
7534 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7535 report using "stats scope".
7536
7537 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7538 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7539 unobvious parameters.
7540
7541 Example :
7542 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7543 backend public_www
7544 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7545 stats enable
7546 stats hide-version
7547 stats scope .
7548 stats uri /admin?stats
7549 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7550 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7551 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7552
7553 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7554 backend private_monitoring
7555 stats enable
7556 stats uri /admin?stats
7557 stats refresh 5s
7558
7559 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7560
7561
7562stats enable
7563 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007565 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007566 Arguments : none
7567
7568 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7569 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7570 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7571 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7572 - stats auth : no authentication
7573 - stats scope : no restriction
7574
7575 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7576 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7577 unobvious parameters.
7578
7579 Example :
7580 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7581 backend public_www
7582 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7583 stats enable
7584 stats hide-version
7585 stats scope .
7586 stats uri /admin?stats
7587 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7588 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7589 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7590
7591 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7592 backend private_monitoring
7593 stats enable
7594 stats uri /admin?stats
7595 stats refresh 5s
7596
7597 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7598
7599
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007600stats hide-version
7601 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007602 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007603 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007604 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007605
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007606 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7607 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7608 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7609 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7610 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7611 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007613 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7614 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7615 unobvious parameters.
7616
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007617 Example :
7618 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7619 backend public_www
7620 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007621 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007622 stats hide-version
7623 stats scope .
7624 stats uri /admin?stats
7625 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7626 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7627 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007628
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007629 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7630 backend private_monitoring
7631 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007632 stats uri /admin?stats
7633 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007634
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007635 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007636
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007637
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007638stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7639 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7640 Access control for statistics
7641
7642 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7643 no | no | yes | yes
7644
7645 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7646 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7647 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7648 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7649 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7650 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7651
7652 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7653 instance.
7654
7655 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7656 about ACL usage.
7657
7658
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007659stats realm <realm>
7660 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007662 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007663 Arguments :
7664 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7665 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7666 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7667
7668 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7669 using a backslash ('\').
7670
7671 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7672 only related to authentication.
7673
7674 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7675 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7676 unobvious parameters.
7677
7678 Example :
7679 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7680 backend public_www
7681 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7682 stats enable
7683 stats hide-version
7684 stats scope .
7685 stats uri /admin?stats
7686 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7687 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7688 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7689
7690 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7691 backend private_monitoring
7692 stats enable
7693 stats uri /admin?stats
7694 stats refresh 5s
7695
7696 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7697
7698
7699stats refresh <delay>
7700 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007702 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007703 Arguments :
7704 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7705 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7706 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7707 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7708 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7709 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7710
7711 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7712 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7713 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7714 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7715
7716 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7717 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7718 unobvious parameters.
7719
7720 Example :
7721 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7722 backend public_www
7723 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7724 stats enable
7725 stats hide-version
7726 stats scope .
7727 stats uri /admin?stats
7728 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7729 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7730 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7731
7732 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7733 backend private_monitoring
7734 stats enable
7735 stats uri /admin?stats
7736 stats refresh 5s
7737
7738 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7739
7740
7741stats scope { <name> | "." }
7742 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007744 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007745 Arguments :
7746 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7747 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7748 section in which the statement appears.
7749
7750 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7751 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7752 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7753 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7754 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7755 exists.
7756
7757 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7758 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7759 unobvious parameters.
7760
7761 Example :
7762 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7763 backend public_www
7764 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7765 stats enable
7766 stats hide-version
7767 stats scope .
7768 stats uri /admin?stats
7769 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7770 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7771 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7772
7773 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7774 backend private_monitoring
7775 stats enable
7776 stats uri /admin?stats
7777 stats refresh 5s
7778
7779 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7780
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007781
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007782stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007783 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007785 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007786
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007787 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007788 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7789
7790 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7791 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7792
7793 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7794 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007795 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007796
7797 Example :
7798 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7799 backend private_monitoring
7800 stats enable
7801 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7802 stats uri /admin?stats
7803 stats refresh 5s
7804
7805 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7806 global section.
7807
7808
7809stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007810 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7812 yes | yes | yes | yes
7813 Arguments : none
7814
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007815 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007816 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
7817 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
7818 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
7819 - IP (socket, server)
7820 - cookie (backend, server)
7821
7822 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7823 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007824 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007825
7826 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
7827
7828
7829stats show-node [ <name> ]
7830 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
7831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007832 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007833 Arguments:
7834 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
7835 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
7836
7837 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7838 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007839 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007840
7841 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7842 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7843 unobvious parameters.
7844
7845 Example:
7846 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7847 backend private_monitoring
7848 stats enable
7849 stats show-node Europe-1
7850 stats uri /admin?stats
7851 stats refresh 5s
7852
7853 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
7854 section.
7855
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007856
7857stats uri <prefix>
7858 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
7859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007860 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007861 Arguments :
7862 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
7863 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
7864 query string.
7865
7866 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
7867 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
7868 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
7869 possible to reach it in the application.
7870
7871 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007872 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007873 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
7874 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
7875 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
7876 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
7877
7878 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
7879 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
7880 an address or a port to statistics only.
7881
7882 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7883 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7884 unobvious parameters.
7885
7886 Example :
7887 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7888 backend public_www
7889 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7890 stats enable
7891 stats hide-version
7892 stats scope .
7893 stats uri /admin?stats
7894 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7895 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7896 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7897
7898 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7899 backend private_monitoring
7900 stats enable
7901 stats uri /admin?stats
7902 stats refresh 5s
7903
7904 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
7905
7906
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007907stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
7908 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007910 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007911
7912 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007913 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007914 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
7915 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
7916 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
7917
7918 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
7919 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
7920 the "stick-table" statement.
7921
7922 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
7923 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
7924 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
7925 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
7926 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
7927
7928 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
7929 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
7930 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
7931 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
7932 transformation rules.
7933
7934 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
7935 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
7936 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
7937 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
7938 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
7939 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
7940 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
7941
7942 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
7943 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
7944 ACL based conditions.
7945
7946 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
7947 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
7948 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
7949 matches can be used as fallbacks.
7950
7951 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
7952 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
7953 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
7954 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
7955
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007956 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7957 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7958 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7959
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007960 Example :
7961 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
7962 # last 30 minutes
7963 backend pop
7964 mode tcp
7965 balance roundrobin
7966 stick store-request src
7967 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
7968 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
7969 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
7970
7971 backend smtp
7972 mode tcp
7973 balance roundrobin
7974 stick match src table pop
7975 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
7976 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
7977
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007978 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02007979 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007980
7981
7982stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
7983 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
7984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7985 no | no | yes | yes
7986
7987 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
7988 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
7989 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
7990 for writing more maintainable configurations.
7991
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007992 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7993 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7994 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7995
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007996 Examples :
7997 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01007998 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007999
8000 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8001 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8002 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8003
8004
8005 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8006 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8007 backend http
8008 mode http
8009 balance roundrobin
8010 stick on src table https
8011 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8012 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8013 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8014
8015 backend https
8016 mode tcp
8017 balance roundrobin
8018 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8019 stick on src
8020 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8021 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8022
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008023 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008024
8025
8026stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8027 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8029 no | no | yes | yes
8030
8031 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008032 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008033 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8034 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8035 server is selected.
8036
8037 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8038 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8039 the "stick-table" statement.
8040
8041 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8042 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8043 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8044 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8045 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8046 address.
8047
8048 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8049 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8050 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8051 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8052 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8053 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8054 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8055 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8056 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8057 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8058
8059 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8060 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8061 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8062 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8063 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8064 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8065 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8066
8067 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8068 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8069 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8070 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8071
8072 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8073 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8074 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8075 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8076 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8077 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008078 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8079 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8080 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8081 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8082 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8083 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008084
8085 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8086 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8087 the request.
8088
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008089 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8090 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8091 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8092
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008093 Example :
8094 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8095 # last 30 minutes
8096 backend pop
8097 mode tcp
8098 balance roundrobin
8099 stick store-request src
8100 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8101 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8102 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8103
8104 backend smtp
8105 mode tcp
8106 balance roundrobin
8107 stick match src table pop
8108 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8109 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8110
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008111 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008112 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008113
8114
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008115stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008116 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8117 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008118 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008120 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008121
8122 Arguments :
8123 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8124 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8125 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8126 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8127
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008128 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8129 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8130 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8131 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8132
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008133 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8134 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8135 instance.
8136
8137 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8138 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8139 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8140 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8141 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8142 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008143 to 32 characters.
8144
8145 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8146 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8147 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008148 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008149 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8150 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008151
8152 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008153 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8154 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008155 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8156 increase.
8157
8158 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008159 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8160 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8161 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008162
8163 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8164 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8165 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8166 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8167 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8168 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8169 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8170 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8171 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8172 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8173 parameter (see below).
8174
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008175 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8176 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8177 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8178 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8179 soft restart.
8180
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008181 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8182 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008183
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008184 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8185 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8186 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8187 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8188 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008189 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008190 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8191 if not expiration delay is specified.
8192
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008193 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8194 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8195 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8196 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008197 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8198 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8199 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8200 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8201 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8202 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8203 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8204 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8205 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8206 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8207 types and their arguments.
8208
8209 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8210 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8211 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8212 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8213
8214 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8215 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8216 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8217 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8218
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008219 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8220 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8221 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8222 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8223 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8224 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8225
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008226 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8227 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8228 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8229 they were received.
8230
8231 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8232 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8233 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8234 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8235 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8236
8237 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8238 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8239 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8240 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8241 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8242
8243 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8244 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8245 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8246
8247 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8248 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8249 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8250 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8251 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8252
8253 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8254 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8255 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8256 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8257 the client side.
8258
8259 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8260 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8261 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8262 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8263 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8264 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8265 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8266
8267 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8268 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8269 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8270 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8271 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8272 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8273 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8274
8275 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8276 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8277 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8278 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8279 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8280 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8281
8282 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8283 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8284 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8285 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8286
8287 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8288 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8289 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8290 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8291 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8292 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8293 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8294 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8295 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8296 recommended for better fairness.
8297
8298 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8299 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8300 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8301 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8302
8303 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8304 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8305 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8306 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8307 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8308 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8309 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8310 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8311 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8312 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008313
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008314 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8315 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008316 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8317 reference it.
8318
8319 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8320 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008321 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8322 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8323 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008324
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008325 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8326 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8327 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8328 something that can be ignored.
8329
8330 Example:
8331 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8332 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8333 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8334 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8335
8336 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008337 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008338
8339
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008340stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008341 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 no | no | yes | yes
8344
8345 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008346 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008347 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8348 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8349 server is selected.
8350
8351 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8352 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8353 the "stick-table" statement.
8354
8355 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8356 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8357 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8358 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8359
8360 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8361 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8362 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8363 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8364 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8365 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008366 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008367 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8368 rules.
8369
8370 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8371 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8372 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8373 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8374 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8375 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8376 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8377
8378 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8379 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8380 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8381 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8382
8383 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8384 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8385 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8386 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8387 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8388 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008389 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8390 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8391 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8392 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8393 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8394 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8395 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8396 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8397 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008398
8399 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8400
8401 Example :
8402 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8403 backend https
8404 mode tcp
8405 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008406 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008407 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008408
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008409 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8410 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8411
8412 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8413 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8414 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8415
8416 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8417 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008418
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008419 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8420 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8421 # at offset 44.
8422
8423 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8424 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8425
8426 # Learn on response if server hello.
8427 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008428
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008429 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8430 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8431
8432 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8433 extraction.
8434
8435
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008436tcp-check connect [params*]
8437 Opens a new connection
8438 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8439 no | no | yes | yes
8440
8441 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8442 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8443 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8444
8445 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8446 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8447 of the sequence.
8448
8449 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8450 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8451 do.
8452
8453 Parameters :
8454 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8455 use the TCP connection.
8456
8457 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8458 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8459 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8460
8461 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8462
8463 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8464
8465 Examples:
8466 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8467 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8468 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8469 option tcp-check
8470 tcp-check connect
8471 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8472 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8473 tcp-check send \r\n
8474 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8475 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8476 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8477 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8478 tcp-check send \r\n
8479 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8480 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8481
8482 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8483 option tcp-check
8484 tcp-check connect port 110
8485 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8486 tcp-check connect port 143
8487 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8488 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8489
8490 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8491
8492
8493tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8494 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8495 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8496 no | no | yes | yes
8497
8498 Arguments :
8499 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8500 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8501 binary.
8502 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8503 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8504 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8505
8506 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8507 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8508 with the usual backslash ('\').
8509 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8510 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8511 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8512 used upper or lower case.
8513
8514
8515 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8516
8517 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8518 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8519 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8520 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8521 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8522 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8523 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8524 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8525
8526 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8527 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8528 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8529 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8530 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8531 expression.
8532
8533 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8534 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8535 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8536 this exact hexadecimal string.
8537 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8538
8539 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8540 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8541 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8542 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8543 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8544 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8545 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8546 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8547 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8548 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8549 the null character.
8550
8551 Examples :
8552 # perform a POP check
8553 option tcp-check
8554 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8555
8556 # perform an IMAP check
8557 option tcp-check
8558 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8559
8560 # look for the redis master server
8561 option tcp-check
8562 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008563 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008564 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8565 tcp-check expect string role:master
8566 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8567 tcp-check expect string +OK
8568
8569
8570 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8571 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8572
8573
8574tcp-check send <data>
8575 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8577 no | no | yes | yes
8578
8579 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8580 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8581
8582 Examples :
8583 # look for the redis master server
8584 option tcp-check
8585 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8586 tcp-check expect string role:master
8587
8588 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8589 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8590
8591
8592tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8593 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8594 tcp health check
8595 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8596 no | no | yes | yes
8597
8598 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8599 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8600 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8601 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8602 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8603 hexadecimal string.
8604 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8605
8606 Examples :
8607 # redis check in binary
8608 option tcp-check
8609 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8610 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8611
8612
8613 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8614 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8615
8616
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008617tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8618 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8620 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008621 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008622 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8623 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008624
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008625 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008626
8627 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8628 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008629 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8630 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8631 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8632 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8633 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8634 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008635
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008636 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8637 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8638 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8639 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008640
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008641 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008642 - accept :
8643 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8644 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8645 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008646
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008647 - reject :
8648 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8649 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8650 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8651 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8652 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8653 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8654 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8655 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8656 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8657 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8658 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
8659 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008660
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008661 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8662 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8663 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8664 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8665 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8666 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8667 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8668 hosts.
8669
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008670 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8671 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8672 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8673 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8674 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8675 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8676 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8677 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8678
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008679 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8680 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8681 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8682 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8683 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8684 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8685 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8686 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8687 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008688 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8689 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008690
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008691 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008692 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008693 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008694 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008695 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8696 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008697 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008698 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8699 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8700 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8701 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8702 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008703
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008704 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008705 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008706 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008707 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8708 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8709 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8710 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008711
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008712 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8713 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8714 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8715 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008716
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008717 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8718 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8719 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8720 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8721 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008722 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8723 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8724 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8725 layer7 information is extracted.
8726
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008727 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8728 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8729 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8730 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8731 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008732
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008733 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8734 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8735 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8736 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8737
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008738 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8739 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8740 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8741 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8742 continues.
8743
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008744 - set-src <expr> :
8745 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8746 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8747 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8748 set-src"
8749
8750 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8751 followed by some converters.
8752
8753 Example:
8754
8755 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8756
8757 When set-src is successful, the source port is set to 0.
8758
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008759 - set-src-port <expr> :
8760 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8761 expression.
8762
8763 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8764 followed by some converters.
8765
8766 Example:
8767
8768 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8769
8770 Be careful to use "set-src-port" after "set-src", because "set-src" sets
8771 the source port to 0.
8772
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008773 - set-dst <expr> :
8774 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8775 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8776 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8777 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8778 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8779
8780 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8781 followed by some converters.
8782
8783 Example:
8784
8785 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8786 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8787
8788 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8789 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8790 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8791 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8792
8793
8794 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8795 followed by some converters.
8796
8797 Example:
8798
8799 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8800
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008801 - "silent-drop" :
8802 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8803 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
8804 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
8805 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
8806 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
8807 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
8808 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
8809 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
8810 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
8811 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
8812 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
8813 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
8814 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
8815 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
8816 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
8817 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
8818
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008819 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
8820 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8821 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008822
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008823 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
8824 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
8825 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008826
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008827 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008828 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008829 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008830
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008831 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
8832 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
8833 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008834
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008835 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008836 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8837 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008838
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008839 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
8840
8841 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
8842
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008843 See section 7 about ACL usage.
8844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008845 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008846
8847
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008848tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8849 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02008851 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008852 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008853 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8854 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008855
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008856 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008858 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
8859 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
8860 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
8861 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
8862 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008863
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008864 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
8865 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
8866 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
8867 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008868 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
8869 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
8870 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
8871 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
8872 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
8873 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008874 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008875 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008876
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008877 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
8878 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
8879 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
8880 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008881
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008882 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008883 - accept : the request is accepted
8884 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
8885 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008886 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008887 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02008888 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008889 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008890 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008891
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008892 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
8893 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008894
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008895 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
8896 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
8897 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
8898 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
8899 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
8900 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008902 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008903 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
8904 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008905
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008906 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008907 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
8908 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
8909 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
8910 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01008911 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
8912 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
8913 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008914
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008915 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008916 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
8917 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
8918 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008919
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008920 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
8921 declared inline.
8922
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008923 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
8924 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
8925 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
8926 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008927 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008928 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008929 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008930 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
8931 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008932 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01008933 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
8934 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008935
8936 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8937 followed by some converters.
8938
8939 Example:
8940
8941 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
8942
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008943 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008944 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
8945 # and reject everything else.
8946 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
8947 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02008948 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008949 tcp-request content reject
8950
8951 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008952 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
8953 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8954 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008955 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008956
8957 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
8958 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
8959 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008960 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008961 tcp-request content reject
8962
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008963 Example:
8964 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
8965 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008966 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008967
8968 Example:
8969 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
8970 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02008971 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008972
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008973 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
8974 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
8975
8976 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008977 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008978 # protecting all our sites
8979 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008980 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
8981 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008982 ...
8983 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
8984
8985 backend http_dynamic
8986 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008987 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008988 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008989 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
8990 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
8991 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008992 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008994 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008995
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008996 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02008997
8998
8999tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9000 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009002 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009003 Arguments :
9004 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9005 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9006 as explained at the top of this document.
9007
9008 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9009 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9010 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9011 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9012 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9013
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009014 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9015 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9016 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9017 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9018
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009019 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9020 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009021 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009022 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009023 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9024 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9025 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9026 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009027
9028 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9029 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9030 it pass through unaffected.
9031
9032 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9033 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9034 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009035 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009036 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9037 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009038 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9039 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9040 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009041
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009042 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009043 "timeout client".
9044
9045
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009046tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9047 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9049 no | no | yes | yes
9050 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009051 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9052 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009053
9054 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9055
9056 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9057 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9058 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009059 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9060 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009061
9062 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9063
9064 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9065 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9066 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9067 inserted.
9068
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009069 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009070 - accept :
9071 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9072 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9073 the rules evaluation.
9074
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009075 - close :
9076 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9077 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9078 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9079 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9080 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9081 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009082 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009083 protocols.
9084
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009085 - reject :
9086 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9087 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009088 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009089
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009090 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9091 Sets a variable.
9092
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009093 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9094 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9095 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9096 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9097
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009098 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9099 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9100 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9101 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9102 continues.
9103
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009104 - "silent-drop" :
9105 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9106 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9107 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9108 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9109 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9110 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9111 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9112 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9113 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9114 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9115 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9116 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9117 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9118 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9119 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9120 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9121
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009122 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9123 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9124 for changing the default action to a reject.
9125
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009126 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9127 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9128 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9129 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009130 period.
9131
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009132 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9133 declared inline.
9134
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009135 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9136 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
9137 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9138 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009139 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009141 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009142 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9143 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009144 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009145 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
9146 and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009147
9148 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9149 followed by some converters.
9150
9151 Example:
9152
9153 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9154
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009155 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9156
9157 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9158
9159
9160tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9161 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9163 no | no | yes | yes
9164 Arguments :
9165 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9166 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9167 as explained at the top of this document.
9168
9169 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9170
9171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009172timeout check <timeout>
9173 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9174 established.
9175
9176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9177 yes | no | yes | yes
9178 Arguments:
9179 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9180 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9181 as explained at the top of this document.
9182
9183 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9184 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9185 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9186 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009187 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9188 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9189 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009190
9191 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9192 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9193
9194 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9195 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009196 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009197
9198 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9199 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9200 forget about it.
9201
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009202 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9203 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009204
9205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009206timeout client <timeout>
9207timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9208 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | yes | yes | no
9211 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009212 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009213 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9214 as explained at the top of this document.
9215
9216 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9217 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9218 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009219 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9220 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9221 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9222 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009223 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9224 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9225 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009226 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009227 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009228 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9229 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009230 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9231 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009232
9233 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9234 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9235 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9236 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9237 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9238 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9239
9240 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9241 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9242 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9243
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009244 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9245 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009246
9247
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009248timeout client-fin <timeout>
9249 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9251 yes | yes | yes | no
9252 Arguments :
9253 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9254 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9255 as explained at the top of this document.
9256
9257 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9258 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9259 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9260 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9261 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9262 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9263 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9264 down in one direction.
9265
9266 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9267 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9268 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9269
9270 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9271
9272
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009273timeout connect <timeout>
9274timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9275 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9277 yes | no | yes | yes
9278 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009279 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009280 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9281 as explained at the top of this document.
9282
9283 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009284 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009285 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009286 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009287 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9288 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009289
9290 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9291 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9292 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9293 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9294 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9295 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9296
9297 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9298 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9299 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9300
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009301 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9302 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009303
9304
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009305timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9306 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9308 yes | yes | yes | yes
9309 Arguments :
9310 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9311 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9312 as explained at the top of this document.
9313
9314 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9315 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9316 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9317 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9318 once the request has started to present itself.
9319
9320 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9321 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9322 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9323 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9324 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9325
9326 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9327 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9328 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9329 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9330
9331 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9332 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9333 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9334 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9335 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009336 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009337
9338 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9339 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9340 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9341 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9342
9343 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9344
9345
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009346timeout http-request <timeout>
9347 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009349 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009350 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009351 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009352 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9353 as explained at the top of this document.
9354
9355 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9356 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9357 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9358 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9359 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9360 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9361 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009362 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9363 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9364 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9365 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9366 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009367 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9368 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009369
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009370 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9371 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9372 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9373 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9374 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009375 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009376
9377 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9378 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9379 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9380 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9381 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9382
9383 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009384 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9385 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9386 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009387
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009388 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009389 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009390
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009391
9392timeout queue <timeout>
9393 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9395 yes | no | yes | yes
9396 Arguments :
9397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9399 as explained at the top of this document.
9400
9401 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9402 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9403 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9404 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9405 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9406
9407 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9408 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9409 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9410 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9411
9412 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9413
9414
9415timeout server <timeout>
9416timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9417 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9419 yes | no | yes | yes
9420 Arguments :
9421 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9422 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9423 as explained at the top of this document.
9424
9425 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9426 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9427 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9428 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9429 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9430 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9431 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9432
9433 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9434 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9435 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9436 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9437 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009438 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009439 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009440 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9441 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9442 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9443 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009444
9445 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9446 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9447 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9448 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9449 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9450 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9451
9452 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9453 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9454 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9455
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009456 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009457
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009458
9459timeout server-fin <timeout>
9460 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9462 yes | no | yes | yes
9463 Arguments :
9464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9466 as explained at the top of this document.
9467
9468 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9469 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9470 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9471 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9472 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9473 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9474 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9475 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9476 situations, it should not be needed.
9477
9478 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9479 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9480 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9481
9482 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9483
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009484
9485timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009486 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009487 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9488 yes | yes | yes | yes
9489 Arguments :
9490 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9491 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9492 as explained at the top of this document.
9493
9494 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9495 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9496 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9497
9498 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9499 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9500 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9501 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009502 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009503
9504 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9505
9506
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009507timeout tunnel <timeout>
9508 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9510 yes | no | yes | yes
9511 Arguments :
9512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9514 as explained at the top of this document.
9515
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009516 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009517 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9518 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9519 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9520 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9521 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9522 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9523 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9524 specified.
9525
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009526 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9527 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9528 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9529 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9530 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9531 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9532 state.
9533
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009534 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9535 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9536 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9537 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9538 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9539
9540 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9541 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9542 forget about it.
9543
9544 Example :
9545 defaults http
9546 option http-server-close
9547 timeout connect 5s
9548 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009549 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009550 timeout server 30s
9551 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9552
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009553 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009554
9555
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009556transparent (deprecated)
9557 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009559 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009560 Arguments : none
9561
9562 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9563 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9564 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9565 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9566 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9567 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9568 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9569 appropriate server.
9570
9571 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9572
9573 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9574 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9575
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009576 See also: "option transparent"
9577
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009578unique-id-format <string>
9579 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9581 yes | yes | yes | no
9582 Arguments :
9583 <string> is a log-format string.
9584
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009585 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9586 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9587 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9588 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009589
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009590 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9591 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9592 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9593 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9594 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9595 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9596 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9597 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009598
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009599 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9600 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009601
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009602 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009603
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009604 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009605
9606 will generate:
9607
9608 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9609
9610 See also: "unique-id-header"
9611
9612unique-id-header <name>
9613 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | yes | yes | no
9616 Arguments :
9617 <name> is the name of the header.
9618
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009619 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9620 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009621
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009622 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009623
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009624 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009625 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9626
9627 will generate:
9628
9629 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9630
9631 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009632
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009633use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009634 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 no | yes | yes | no
9637 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009638 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9639 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009640
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009641 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9642 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009643
9644 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9645 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9646 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009647 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9648 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9649 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9650 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009651
9652 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9653 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9654 assign the backend.
9655
9656 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9657 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9658 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9659 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9660 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9661 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9662
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009663 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009664 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009665 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9666 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9667 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9668
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009669 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9670 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9671 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9672 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9673 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9674 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9675 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9676 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9677 cannot be forced from the request.
9678
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009679 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009680 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9681 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9682
9683 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9684 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009685
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009686
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009687use-server <server> if <condition>
9688use-server <server> unless <condition>
9689 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9691 no | no | yes | yes
9692 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009693 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009694
9695 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9696
9697 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9698 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9699 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9700
9701 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
9702 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
9703 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
9704 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
9705 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
9706 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
9707 matches will assign the server.
9708
9709 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
9710 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
9711 with the next rules until one matches.
9712
9713 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
9714 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9715 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
9716 according to other persistence mechanisms.
9717
9718 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
9719 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
9720 stripped.
9721
9722 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
9723 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
9724 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
9725 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
9726
9727 Example :
9728 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
9729 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
9730 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
9731 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
9732 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
9733 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
9734 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
9735 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
9736 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
9737
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009738 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009739
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009740
97415. Bind and Server options
9742--------------------------
9743
9744The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
9745depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
9746settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
9747written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
9748described in this section.
9749
9750
97515.1. Bind options
9752-----------------
9753
9754The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
9755as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
9756no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
9757parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
9758while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
9759provided immediately after the setting name.
9760
9761The currently supported settings are the following ones.
9762
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009763accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
9764 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
9765 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
9766 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
9767 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
9768 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
9769 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
9770 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
9771 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
9772 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009773 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
9774 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
9775 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +01009776
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009777accept-proxy
9778 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +02009779 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
9780 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009781 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
9782 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
9783 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
9784 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
9785 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
9786 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
9787 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009788 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
9789 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009790
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02009791alpn <protocols>
9792 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
9793 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
9794 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
9795 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
9796 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
9797 initial NPN extension.
9798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009799backlog <backlog>
9800 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
9801 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
9802
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009803ecdhe <named curve>
9804 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01009805 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
9806 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02009807
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009808ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9810 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
9811 client's certificate.
9812
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009813ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
9814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
9815 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
9816 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
9817 error is ignored.
9818
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02009819ca-sign-file <cafile>
9820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9821 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
9822 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
9823 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9824 'generate-certificates' for details.
9825
9826ca-sign-passphrase <passphrase>
9827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
9828 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
9829 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
9830 'generate-certificates' for details.
9831
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009832ciphers <ciphers>
9833 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
9834 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009835 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009836 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
9837 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
9838
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02009839crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02009840 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9841 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
9842 to verify client's certificate.
9843
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009844crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009845 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
9846 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
9847 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
9848 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
9849 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
9850 file.
9851
9852 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
9853 are loaded.
9854
9855 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009856 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009857 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
9858 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
9859 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
9860 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
9861 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
9862 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
9863 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009864
9865 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
9866 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
9867 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
9868 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +01009869 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
9870 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009871
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02009872 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009873
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009874 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
9875 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08009876 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009877 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
9878 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
9879 clients).
9880
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +02009881 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
9882 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
9883 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
9884 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
9885 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
9886 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
9887 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
9888 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
9889 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
9890 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
9891 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
9892 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
9893 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
9894
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +01009895 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
9896 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
9897 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
9898 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
9899 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
9900
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009901 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
9902 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
9903 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
9904 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009905
9906 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
9907 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
9908 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
9909 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
9910 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
9911 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
9912 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
9913 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
9914 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
9915
9916 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
9917
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009918 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009919 a cert bundle.
9920
9921 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
9922 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
9923 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
9924 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
9925 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
9926 provide multi-cert support.
9927
9928 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
9929
9930 Filename | CN | SAN
9931 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9932 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009933 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009934 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
9935 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
9936
9937 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
9938 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
9939 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
9940 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
9941 suites.
9942
9943 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
9944 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
9945
9946 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
9947 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
9948 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
9949
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009950crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009951 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
9952 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009953 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00009954 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02009955
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009956crt-list <file>
9957 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009958 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
9959 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009960
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009961 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009962
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02009963 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
9964 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
9965 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
9966 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
9967 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
9968 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
9969 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
9970 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01009971
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -05009972 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +02009973 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
9974 all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -05009975
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009976defer-accept
9977 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
9978 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
9979 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
9980 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
9981 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
9982 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
9983 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
9984 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
9985 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
9986 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
9987 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
9988
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009989force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009990 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009991 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009992 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
9993 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009994
9995force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009996 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01009997 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
9998 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02009999
10000force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010001 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010002 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10003 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010004
10005force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010006 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010007 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10008 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010009
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010010generate-certificates
10011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10012 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10013 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10014 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10015 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10016 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10017 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10018 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10019 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10020 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10021 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10022
10023 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10024 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10025 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10026 certificate is used many times.
10027
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010028gid <gid>
10029 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10030 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10031 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10032 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10033 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10034
10035group <group>
10036 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10037 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10038 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10039 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10040 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10041
10042id <id>
10043 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10044 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10045 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10046 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10047
10048interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010049 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10050 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10051 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10052 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10053 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10054 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10055 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010056
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010057level <level>
10058 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10059 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10060 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10061 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10062 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10063 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10064 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10065 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10066 counters).
10067 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10068 all counters).
10069
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010070maxconn <maxconn>
10071 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10072 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10073 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10074 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10075 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10076 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10077 eat all memory.
10078
10079mode <mode>
10080 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10081 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10082 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10083 UNIX sockets.
10084
10085mss <maxseg>
10086 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10087 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10088 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10089 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10090 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10091 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10092 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10093 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10094 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10095 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10096 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10097
10098name <name>
10099 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10100 page.
10101
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010102namespace <name>
10103 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10104 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10105 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10106 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010108nice <nice>
10109 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10110 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10111 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10112 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10113 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10114 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10115 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10116 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10117 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10118 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10119 one for an RDP socket.
10120
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010121no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010123 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010124 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010125 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10126 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010127 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010128
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010129no-tls-tickets
10130 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10131 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10132 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010133 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10134 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010135
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010136no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010137 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010138 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010139 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010140 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10141 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10142 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010143
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010144no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010145 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010146 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010147 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010148 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10149 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10150 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010151
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010152no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010153 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010154 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010155 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010156 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10157 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10158 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010159
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010160npn <protocols>
10161 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10162 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10163 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10164 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010165 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10166 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010167
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010168process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10169 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10170 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10171 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10172 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10173 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10174 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10175 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010176 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10177 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10178 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10179 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10180 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10181 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10182 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010184ssl
10185 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010186 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010187 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10188 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10189 to deciphered contents.
10190
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010191strict-sni
10192 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10193 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10194 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10195 See the "crt" option for more information.
10196
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010197tcp-ut <delay>
10198 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instanciated from this
10199 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10200 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
10201 receiving an acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
10202 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10203 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10204 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10205 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10206 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10207 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10208 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10209
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010210tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010211 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010212 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10213 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10214 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10215 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10216 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10217 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10218 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010219 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10220 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10221 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010222
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010223tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10224 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10225 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10226 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10227 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10228 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10229 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10230 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10231 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10232 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10233 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10234
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010235transparent
10236 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10237 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10238 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10239 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10240 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10241 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10242 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10243 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10244 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10245 so check for support with your vendor.
10246
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010247v4v6
10248 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10249 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10250 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10251 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010252 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010253
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010254v6only
10255 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10256 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10257 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010258 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10259 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010261uid <uid>
10262 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10263 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10264 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10265 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10266 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10267
10268user <user>
10269 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10270 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10271 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10272 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10273 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10274
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010275verify [none|optional|required]
10276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10277 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10278 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10279 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10280 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010281 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10282 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10283 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10284 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010285
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200102865.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010287------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010288
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010289The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10290which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10291arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10292settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10293after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10294Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10295address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010297 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010298 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010300The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010301
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010302addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010303 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010304 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10305 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10306 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10307 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10308 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010310 Supported in default-server: No
10311
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010312agent-check
10313 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010314 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10315 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10316 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10317 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010318
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010319 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010320 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010321 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10322 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10323 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010324
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010325 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10326 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10327 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10328 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10329 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10330
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010331 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10332 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010333
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010334 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10335 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10336 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010337
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010338 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10339 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10340 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010341
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010342 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10343 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10344 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10345 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10346 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10347 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10348 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010349
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010350 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10351 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010352
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010353 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10354 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10355 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10356 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10357 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10358 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10359 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10360 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10361 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010362
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010363 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10364 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010365 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10366 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10367 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010368 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010369
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010370 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10371 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010372
10373 Supported in default-server: No
10374
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010375agent-send <string>
10376 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10377 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10378 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10379 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10380 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10381
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010382agent-inter <delay>
10383 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10384 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10385
10386 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10387 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10388 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10389 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10390 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10391 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10392 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10393 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10394 of backends use the same servers.
10395
10396 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10397
10398 Supported in default-server: Yes
10399
10400agent-port <port>
10401 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10402
10403 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10404
10405 Supported in default-server: Yes
10406
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010407backup
10408 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10409 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10410 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10411 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10412 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10413 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010414
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010415 Supported in default-server: No
10416
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010417ca-file <cafile>
10418 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10419 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10420 server's certificate.
10421
10422 Supported in default-server: No
10423
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010424check
10425 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010426 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10427 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10428 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10429 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10430 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10431 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10432 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010433 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10434 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10435 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010437 Supported in default-server: No
10438
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010439check-send-proxy
10440 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10441 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10442 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10443 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10444 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10445 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10446 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10447
10448 Supported in default-server: No
10449
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010450check-ssl
10451 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10452 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10453 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10454 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010455 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010456 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10457 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10458 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10459 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10460
10461 Supported in default-server: No
10462
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010463ciphers <ciphers>
10464 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010465 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010466 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10467 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10468 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10469 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10470 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10471 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10472
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010473 Supported in default-server: No
10474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010475cookie <value>
10476 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10477 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10478 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10479 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10480 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10481 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10482 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10483
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010484 Supported in default-server: No
10485
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010486crl-file <crlfile>
10487 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10488 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10489 to verify server's certificate.
10490
10491 Supported in default-server: No
10492
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010493crt <cert>
10494 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10495 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10496 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10497 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10498 certificate request.
10499
10500 Supported in default-server: No
10501
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010502disabled
10503 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10504 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10505 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10506 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10507 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10508
10509 Supported in default-server: No
10510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010511error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010512 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10513 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10514 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010515
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010516 Supported in default-server: Yes
10517
10518 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010519
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010520fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010521 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10522 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10523 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10524
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010525 Supported in default-server: Yes
10526
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010527force-sslv3
10528 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10529 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010530 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10531 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010532
10533 Supported in default-server: No
10534
10535force-tlsv10
10536 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010537 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10538 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010539
10540 Supported in default-server: No
10541
10542force-tlsv11
10543 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010544 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10545 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010546
10547 Supported in default-server: No
10548
10549force-tlsv12
10550 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010551 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10552 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010553
10554 Supported in default-server: No
10555
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010556id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010557 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10558 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10559 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010561 Supported in default-server: No
10562
10563inter <delay>
10564fastinter <delay>
10565downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010566 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10567 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10568 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10569 between checks depending on the server state :
10570
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010571 Server state | Interval used
10572 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10573 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10574 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10575 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10576 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10577 or yet unchecked. |
10578 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10579 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10580 | "inter" otherwise.
10581 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010582
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010583 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10584 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10585 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10586 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010587 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10588 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10589 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10590 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10591 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010592
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010593 Supported in default-server: Yes
10594
10595maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010596 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10597 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10598 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10599 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10600 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10601 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10602 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10603 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010605 Supported in default-server: Yes
10606
10607maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010608 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10609 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10610 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10611 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10612 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10613 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10614 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010616 Supported in default-server: Yes
10617
10618minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010619 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10620 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10621 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10622 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10623 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10624 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010625 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010626 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010627
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010628 Supported in default-server: Yes
10629
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010630namespace <name>
10631 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10632 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10633 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10634 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10635
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010636no-ssl-reuse
10637 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10638 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10639 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10640 and for paranoid users.
10641
10642 Supported in default-server: No
10643
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010644no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010645 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
10646 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010647 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010648
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010649 Supported in default-server: No
10650
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010651no-tls-tickets
10652 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10653 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10654 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010655 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
10656 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020010657
10658 Supported in default-server: No
10659
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010660no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010661 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010662 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10663 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010664 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10665 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10666 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010667
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010668 Supported in default-server: No
10669
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010670no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010671 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010672 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10673 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010674 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10675 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10676 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010677
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010678 Supported in default-server: No
10679
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010680no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010681 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010682 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
10683 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010684 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
10685 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
10686 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010687
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010688 Supported in default-server: No
10689
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090010690non-stick
10691 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
10692 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
10693 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
10694
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010695 Supported in default-server: No
10696
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010697observe <mode>
10698 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
10699 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
10700 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
10701 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
10702 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
10703 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010010704 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010706 Supported in default-server: No
10707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010708 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
10709
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010710on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010711 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
10712 Currently, four modes are available:
10713 - fastinter: force fastinter
10714 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
10715 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
10716 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
10717 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
10718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010719 Supported in default-server: Yes
10720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010721 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
10722
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010723on-marked-down <action>
10724 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
10725 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010726 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
10727 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
10728 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
10729 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
10730 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
10731 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
10732 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
10733 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090010734
10735 Actions are disabled by default
10736
10737 Supported in default-server: Yes
10738
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070010739on-marked-up <action>
10740 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
10741 Currently one action is available:
10742 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
10743 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
10744 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
10745 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
10746 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
10747 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
10748 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
10749 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
10750
10751 Actions are disabled by default
10752
10753 Supported in default-server: Yes
10754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010755port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010756 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
10757 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
10758 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
10759 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
10760 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
10761 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
10762
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010763 Supported in default-server: Yes
10764
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010765redir <prefix>
10766 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
10767 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
10768 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
10769 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
10770 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
10771 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
10772 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
10773 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010774 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010775 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
10776 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
10777 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
10778 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
10779 loop between the client and HAProxy!
10780
10781 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
10782
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010783 Supported in default-server: No
10784
10785rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010786 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
10787 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
10788 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
10789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010790 Supported in default-server: Yes
10791
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010792resolve-prefer <family>
10793 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
10794 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
10795 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
10796 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
10797
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020010798 Default value: ipv6
10799
10800 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010801
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010802 Example:
10803
10804 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010805
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010806resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
10807 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
10808 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
10809 avalailibility service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
10810 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
10811 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
10812 configured network, another address is selected.
10813
10814 Supported in default-server: Yes
10815
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010816 Example:
10817
10818 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010010819
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010820resolvers <id>
10821 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
10822 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010823 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
10824 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
10825 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
10826 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010827
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020010828 Supported in default-server: No
10829
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010830 Example:
10831
10832 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010833
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020010834 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020010835
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010836send-proxy
10837 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
10838 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
10839 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
10840 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010841 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
10842 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
10843 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
10844 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
10845 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
10846 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
10847 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
10848 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
10849 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
10850 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
10851 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
10852 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010010853
10854 Supported in default-server: No
10855
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040010856send-proxy-v2
10857 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
10858 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10859 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10860 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10861 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
10862 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
10863 option of the "bind" keyword.
10864
10865 Supported in default-server: No
10866
10867send-proxy-v2-ssl
10868 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10869 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10870 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10871 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10872 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10873 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
10874 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
10875 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10876
10877 Supported in default-server: No
10878
10879send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
10880 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
10881 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
10882 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
10883 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
10884 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
10885 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
10886 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
10887 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
10888 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
10889
10890 Supported in default-server: No
10891
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010892slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010893 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
10894 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
10895 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
10896 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
10897 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
10898 parameters :
10899
10900 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
10901 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
10902
10903 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
10904 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
10905 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
10906 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
10907
10908 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
10909 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
10910 seen as failed.
10911
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010912 Supported in default-server: Yes
10913
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020010914sni <expression>
10915 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
10916 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
10917 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
10918 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
10919 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
10920
10921 Supported in default-server: no
10922
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010923source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010924source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010925source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010926 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
10927 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
10928 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
10929 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
10930
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010931 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
10932 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
10933 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
10934 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
10935 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
10936 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
10937 server.
10938
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000010939 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
10940 specifying the source address without port(s).
10941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010942 Supported in default-server: No
10943
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010944ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010945 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
10946 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
10947 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
10948 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
10949 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
10950 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010951 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010952
10953 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010954
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020010955tcp-ut <delay>
10956 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
10957 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
10958 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
10959 acknoledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
10960 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
10961 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
10962 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
10963 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
10964 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
10965 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
10966 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
10967 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
10968 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010970track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020010971 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
10972 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
10973 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
10974 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010975 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
10976
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010977 Supported in default-server: No
10978
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010979verify [none|required]
10980 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010010981 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
10982 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
10983 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
10984 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020010985 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
10986 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
10987 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010988
10989 Supported in default-server: No
10990
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070010991verifyhost <hostname>
10992 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
10993 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
10994 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
10995 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
10996 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
10997 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
10998
10999 Supported in default-server: No
11000
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011001weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011002 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11003 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11004 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011005 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11006 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11007 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11008 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11009 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11010 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011012 Supported in default-server: Yes
11013
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011014
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110155.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11016-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011017
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011018HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11019using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11020configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011021This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11022can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11023workload.
11024This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11025resolution at run time.
11026Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11027carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11028
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011029Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11030health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11031
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011032
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110335.3.1. Global overview
11034----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011035
11036As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11037different steps of the process life:
11038
11039 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11040 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11041 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11042
11043 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11044 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11045 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11046
11047A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11048 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11049 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11050 resolution to know this new IP.
11051
11052A few things important to notice:
11053 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11054 first valid response.
11055
11056 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11057 servers return an error.
11058
11059
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200110605.3.2. The resolvers section
11061----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011062
11063This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11064HAProxy.
11065There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11066many name servers.
11067
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011068When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11069uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11070is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11071answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11072
11073When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11074used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11075
11076Two types of behavior can be applied:
11077 1. stop DNS resolution
11078 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11079 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11080 1. ANY query type
11081 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11082 server's parameter
11083 3. remaining family type
11084
11085HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11086 - invalid DNS response packet
11087 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11088 - NX domain
11089 - Query refused by server
11090 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11091
11092HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11093 - no Answer records in the response
11094 - DNS response truncated
11095 - Error in DNS response
11096 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11097 - name server timeout
11098
11099For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11100 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11101 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11102 applied;
11103 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11104 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11105 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11106 stops resolution.
11107
11108
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011109resolvers <resolvers id>
11110 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11111
11112A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11113
11114nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11115 DNS server description:
11116 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11117 <ip> : IP address of the server
11118 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11119
11120hold <status> <period>
11121 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11122 on last resolution <status>
11123 <status> : last name resolution status. Only "valid" is accepted for now.
11124 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11125 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11126 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11127
11128 Default value is 10s for "valid".
11129
11130 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11131 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11132 the healch check.
11133
11134resolve_retries <nb>
11135 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11136 giving up.
11137 Default value: 3
11138
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011139 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11140 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11141 type.
11142
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011143timeout <event> <time>
11144 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11145 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11146 events available are:
11147 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11148 been received.
11149 Default value: 1s
11150 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11151 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11152
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011153 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011154
11155 resolvers mydns
11156 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11157 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11158 resolve_retries 3
11159 timeout retry 1s
11160 hold valid 10s
11161
11162
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111636. HTTP header manipulation
11164---------------------------
11165
11166In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11167response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11168request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11169which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011170against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011171
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011172If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11173to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11174but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11175HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11176stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11177because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11178a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11179still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011180
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011181This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11182in section 4.2 :
11183
11184 - reqadd <string>
11185 - reqallow <search>
11186 - reqiallow <search>
11187 - reqdel <search>
11188 - reqidel <search>
11189 - reqdeny <search>
11190 - reqideny <search>
11191 - reqpass <search>
11192 - reqipass <search>
11193 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11194 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11195 - reqtarpit <search>
11196 - reqitarpit <search>
11197 - rspadd <string>
11198 - rspdel <search>
11199 - rspidel <search>
11200 - rspdeny <search>
11201 - rspideny <search>
11202 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11203 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11204
11205With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11206is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11207parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11208prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11209Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11210
11211 \t for a tab
11212 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11213 \n for a new line (LF)
11214 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11215 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11216 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11217 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11218 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11219
11220The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11221portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11222above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11223regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
112249 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11225is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11226
11227The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11228after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11229
11230Notes related to these keywords :
11231---------------------------------
11232 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11233 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11234 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11235
11236 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11237 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11238 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11239
11240 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11241 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11242 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11243 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11244 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11245
11246 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11247 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11248 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11249 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11250 useless headers before adding new ones.
11251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011252 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011253 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11254
11255 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11256 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11257 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11258
11259 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11260 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011261 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011262
11263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200112647. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11265----------------------------------
11266
11267Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11268client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11269The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11270these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11271but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11272data called patterns.
11273
11274
112757.1. ACL basics
11276---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011277
11278The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11279content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11280from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11281simple :
11282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011283 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011284 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011285 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11286 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11289adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011290
11291In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011293 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011294
11295This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11296Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11297and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011298an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11299conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11300as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11301are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011302
11303ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11304'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11305which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11306
11307There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11308performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011310The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11311specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11312this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011313methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11314ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011315
11316Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11317 - boolean
11318 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11319 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11320 - string
11321 - data block
11322
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011323Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11324converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11325would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11326The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11327which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11328
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011329Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11330keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11331fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11332which are summarized in the table below :
11333
11334 +---------------------+-----------------+
11335 | Sample or converter | Default |
11336 | output type | matching method |
11337 +---------------------+-----------------+
11338 | boolean | bool |
11339 +---------------------+-----------------+
11340 | integer | int |
11341 +---------------------+-----------------+
11342 | ip | ip |
11343 +---------------------+-----------------+
11344 | string | str |
11345 +---------------------+-----------------+
11346 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11347 +---------------------+-----------------+
11348
11349Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11350matching method, see below.
11351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11353 - boolean
11354 - integer or integer range
11355 - IP address / network
11356 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11357 - regular expression
11358 - hex block
11359
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011360The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11361
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011362 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11363 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011364 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011365 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011366 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011367 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011368 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011370The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11371read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11372if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11373lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11374will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11375beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11376a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11377lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11378exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11379
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011380The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11381parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11382ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11383a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11384check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11385
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011386The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11387socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11388file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11389
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011390Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11391loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11392
11393 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11394
11395In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11396the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11397case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11398as well.
11399
11400The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11401sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11402do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11403methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11404is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11405obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11406followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11407default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11408that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11409string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11410
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011411The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11412By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11413string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11414resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11415server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11416waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11417flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11418function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11419
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011420There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11421sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11422be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011423
11424 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11425 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011426 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11427 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11428 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11429 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011430
11431 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11432 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011433 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011434
11435 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011436 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011437
11438 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011439 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011440
11441 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11442 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11443
11444 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11445 binary or string samples.
11446
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011447 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11448 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011450 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11451 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11452 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011454 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11455 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011457 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11458 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011460 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11461 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011462
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011463 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11464 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011465 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011467 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11468 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11469 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011470
11471For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11472request, it is possible to do :
11473
11474 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11475
11476In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11477buffer, one would use the following acl :
11478
11479 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11480
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011481On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11482possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11483
11484 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011486All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11487criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11488method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11489to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11490criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11491the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011493If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011494the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11495For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011497 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11498 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11499 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11500 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011501
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011502
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011503The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11504types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11505combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11506brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11507default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011509 +-------------------------------------------------+
11510 | Input sample type |
11511 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011512 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011513 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11514 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11515 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011516 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011517 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011518 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011519 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011520 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011521 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011522 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011523 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011524 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011525 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011526 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011527 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011528 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011529 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011530 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011531 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011532 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011533 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011534 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011535 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011536 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011537 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11538 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11539 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011540
11541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115427.1.1. Matching booleans
11543------------------------
11544
11545In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11546Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11547When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11548that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11549
11550Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11551return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11552"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11553
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115557.1.2. Matching integers
11556------------------------
11557
11558Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11559enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11560to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11561
11562Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11563matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11564lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011565
11566For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11567unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11568representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11569
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011570As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11571two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11572instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11573ranges and operators.
11574
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011575For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011576operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11577Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11578of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011580Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011581
11582 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11583 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11584 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11585 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11586 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11587
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011588For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011589
11590 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11591
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011592This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11593
11594 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11595
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200115977.1.3. Matching strings
11598-----------------------
11599
11600String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11601different forms :
11602
11603 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11604 patterns ;
11605
11606 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11607 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11608
11609 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11610 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11611
11612 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11613 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11614
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011615 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011616 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11617 matches.
11618
11619 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11620 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11621 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011622
11623String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11624exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11625characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11626string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11627to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011628before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011629
11630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116317.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11632---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011633
11634Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11635they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11636possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11637passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
11638the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011639the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
11640match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011641
11642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116437.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
11644-------------------------------------
11645
11646It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
11647not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
11648a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
11649to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
11650digits may be used upper or lower case.
11651
11652Example :
11653 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
11654 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
11655
11656
116577.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
11658---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011659
11660IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
11661netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
11662within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011663host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011664difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
11665at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
11666does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
11667parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011668
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020011669The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
11670abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
11671
11672 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11673 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
11674 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11675 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
11676 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
11677 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
11678 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
11679 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
11680
11681Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
11682192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
11683
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011684IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
11685Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
11686trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
11687IPv6 patterns.
11688
11689HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
11690following situations :
11691 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
11692 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
11693 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
11694 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
11695 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
11696 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
11697 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
11698 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
11699 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
11700 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
11701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011702
117037.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
11704----------------------------------
11705
11706Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
11707combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
11708
11709 - AND (implicit)
11710 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
11711 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011713A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011715 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011717Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
11718indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020011719
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011720For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
11721"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
11722requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
11723is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
11724
11725 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11726 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
11727 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
11728 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
11729
11730To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
11731and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
11732
11733 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
11734 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
11735 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
11736 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
11737
11738 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
11739 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
11740 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
11741 use_backend www if host_www
11742
11743It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
11744expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
11745be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
11746the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
11747
11748 The following rule :
11749
11750 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
11751 block if METH_POST missing_cl
11752
11753 Can also be written that way :
11754
11755 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
11756
11757It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
11758to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
11759simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
11760sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
11761good use is the following :
11762
11763 With named ACLs :
11764
11765 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
11766 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
11767 monitor fail if site_dead
11768
11769 With anonymous ACLs :
11770
11771 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
11772
11773See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
11774
11775
117767.3. Fetching samples
11777---------------------
11778
11779Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
11780against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
11781sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
11782ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
11783of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
11784available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
11785
11786This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
11787Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
11788compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
11789deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
11790
11791The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
11792matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
11793method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
11794indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
11795
11796As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
11797when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
11798mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
11799the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
11800ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
11801
11802Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
11803multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
11804when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
11805incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
11806are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
11807is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
11808all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
11809
11810Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
11811 - name
11812 - name(arg1)
11813 - name(arg1,arg2)
11814
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011815
118167.3.1. Converters
11817-----------------
11818
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011819Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
11820of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
11821is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
11822was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
11823has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
11824unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
11825
11826These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
11827sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
11828the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
11829support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011830
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011831A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
11832support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
11833supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
11834(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
11835bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
11836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011837The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011838
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011839add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011840 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011841 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011842 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
11843 scopes allowed are:
11844 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11845 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11846 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11847 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11848 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011849 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011850
11851and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011852 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011853 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011854 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
11855 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
11856 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11857 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11858 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11859 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11860 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011861 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011862
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020011863base64
11864 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
11865 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
11866 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
11867
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011868bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011869 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011870 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
11871 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
11872 presence of a flag).
11873
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010011874bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
11875 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
11876 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
11877 optionnaly truncated at the given length.
11878
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011879cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011880 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
11881 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011882
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011883crc32([<avalanche>])
11884 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
11885 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11886 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11887 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11888 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11889 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
11890 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
11891 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
11892 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
11893 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
11894 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
11895
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010011896da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011897 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
11898 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
11899 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
11900 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011901 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011902 configuration language.
11903
11904 Example:
11905 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011906 bind *:8881
11907 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000011908 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020011909
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020011910debug
11911 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
11912 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
11913 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
11914
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011915div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011916 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
11917 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011918 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011919 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11920 scope. The scopes allowed are:
11921 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11922 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
11923 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
11924 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
11925 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020011926 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011927
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011928djb2([<avalanche>])
11929 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
11930 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
11931 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
11932 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
11933 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
11934 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
11935 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010011936 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
11937 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020011938
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011939even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020011940 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010011941 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
11942
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010011943field(<index>,<delimiters>)
11944 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
11945 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
11946 list of chars.
11947
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011948hex
11949 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
11950 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
11951 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
11952 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010011953
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020011954http_date([<offset>])
11955 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
11956 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
11957 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
11958 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
11959 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
11960 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020011962in_table(<table>)
11963 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
11964 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
11965 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
11966 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
11967 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
11968
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020011969ipmask(<mask>)
11970 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
11971 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
11972 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
11973 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
11974
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011975json([<input-code>])
11976 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
11977 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020011978 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020011979 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
11980 of errors:
11981 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
11982 bytes, ...)
11983 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
11984 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
11985
11986 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
11987 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
11988 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
11989 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
11990 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
11991 are :
11992 - "ascii" : never fails ;
11993 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
11994 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
11995 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
11996 error ;
11997 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
11998 characters corresponding to the other errors.
11999
12000 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12001 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12002
12003 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012004 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012005 capture request header user-agent len 150
12006 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012007
12008 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12009 GET / HTTP/1.0
12010 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12011
12012 Output log:
12013 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12014
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012015language(<value>[,<default>])
12016 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12017 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12018 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12019 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12020 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12021 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12022 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12023 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12024 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12025 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12026 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12027 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012028
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012029 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012030
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012031 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12032 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012033
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012034 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12035 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12036 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12037 use_backend spanish if es
12038 use_backend french if fr
12039 use_backend english if en
12040 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012041
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012042lower
12043 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12044 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12045 type. The result is of type string.
12046
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012047ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12048 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12049 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12050 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12051 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12052 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12053 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12054
12055 Example :
12056
12057 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12058 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12059 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012061map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12062map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12063map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12064 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12065 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12066 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12067 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12068 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12069 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12070 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12071 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012072
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012073 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12074 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12075 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012076
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012077 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
12078 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012079
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012080 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12081 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12082 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12083 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012084 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12085 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012086 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12087 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12088 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12089 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12090 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12091 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12092 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12093 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012094 | | map_reg | |
12095 str | reg +-----------------+ map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12096 | | map_regm | |
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012097 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12098 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12099 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12100 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12101 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012102
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012103 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12104 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12105 the corresponding match text.
12106
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012107 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12108 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12109 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12110 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12111 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012112
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012113 Example :
12114
12115 # this is a comment and is ignored
12116 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12117 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12118 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12119 | | | `---------- value
12120 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12121 | `---------------------------- key
12122 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12123
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012124mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012125 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12126 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012127 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012128 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12129 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12130 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12131 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12132 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12133 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012134 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012135
12136mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012137 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012138 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12139 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012140 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012141 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12142 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12143 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12144 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12145 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12146 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012147 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012148
12149neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012150 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12151 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12152 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12153 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012154
12155not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012156 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012157 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12158 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12159 absence of a flag).
12160
12161odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012162 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012163 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12164
12165or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012166 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012167 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012168 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12169 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12170 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12171 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12172 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12173 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12174 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012175 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012176
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012177regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012178 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12179 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12180 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12181 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12182 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12183 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12184 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12185 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12186 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12187 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012188 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12189 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12190 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12191 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012192
12193 Example :
12194
12195 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12196 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12197 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12198 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12199
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012200capture-req(<id>)
12201 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12202 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12203
12204 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012205 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12206 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012207
12208capture-res(<id>)
12209 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12210 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12211
12212 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012213 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12214 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012215
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012216sdbm([<avalanche>])
12217 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12218 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12219 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12220 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12221 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12222 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12223 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012224 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12225 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012226
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012227set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012228 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12229 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12230 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012233 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012234 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12235 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012236 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12237 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12238
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012239sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012240 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12241 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012242 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012243 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12244 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12245 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12246 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012247 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012248 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12249 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012250 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12251 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012252
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012253table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12254 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12255 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12256 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12257 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12258 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12259 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12260
12261
12262table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12263 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12264 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12265 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12266 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12267 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12268 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12269
12270table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12271 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12272 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12273 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12274 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12275 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12276
12277table_conn_cur(<table>)
12278 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12279 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12280 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12281 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12282 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12283
12284table_conn_rate(<table>)
12285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12288 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12289 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12290
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012291table_gpt0(<table>)
12292 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12293 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12294 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12295 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12296 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12297
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012298table_gpc0(<table>)
12299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12301 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12302 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12303 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12304
12305table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12308 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12309 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12310 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12311 sample fetch keyword.
12312
12313table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12314 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12315 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12316 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12317 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12318 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12319
12320table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12323 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12324 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12325 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12326 keyword.
12327
12328table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12331 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12332 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12333 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12334
12335table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12336 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12337 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12338 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12339 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12340 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12341 keyword.
12342
12343table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12344 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12345 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12346 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12347 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12348 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12349 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12350 keyword.
12351
12352table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12353 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12354 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12355 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12356 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12357 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12358 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12359 keyword.
12360
12361table_server_id(<table>)
12362 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12363 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12364 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12365 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12366 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12367 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12368
12369table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12370 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12371 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12372 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12373 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12374 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12375 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12376 keyword.
12377
12378table_sess_rate(<table>)
12379 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12380 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12381 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12382 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12383 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12384 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12385 keyword.
12386
12387table_trackers(<table>)
12388 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12389 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12390 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12391 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12392 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12393 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12394 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12395 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12396 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12397 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12398
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012399upper
12400 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12401 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12402 type. The result is of type string.
12403
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012404url_dec
12405 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12406 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12407
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012408utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12409 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12410 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12411 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12412 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12413 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12414 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12415
12416 Example :
12417
12418 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12419 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12420 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12421
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012422word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12423 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12424 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12425
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012426wt6([<avalanche>])
12427 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12428 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12429 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12430 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12431 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12432 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12433 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012434 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12435 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012436
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012437xor(<value>)
12438 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012439 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012440 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012441 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12442 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12443 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012444 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012445 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12446 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012447 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12448 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012449
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012450
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200124517.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012452--------------------------------------------
12453
12454A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12455not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12456"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12457The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12458
12459always_false : boolean
12460 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12461 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12462
12463always_true : boolean
12464 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12465 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12466
12467avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012468 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012469 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12470 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12471 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12472 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12473 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12474 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12475 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12476 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12477 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12478 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12479 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12480 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12481 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012483be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012484 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12485 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12486 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12487 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12488 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012490be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12491 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12492 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12493 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12494 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12495 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12496 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012497
12498 Example :
12499 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12500 backend dynamic
12501 mode http
12502 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12503 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012504
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012505bin(<hexa>) : bin
12506 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12507 of the string.
12508
12509bool(<bool>) : bool
12510 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12511 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012513connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12514 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012515 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012516 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12517 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012518
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012519 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012520 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012521 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12522
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012523 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12524 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012525
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012526 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012527 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012528 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012529 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12530 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012531 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012532 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012533
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012534 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12535 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012536 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012537 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012538
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012539date([<offset>]) : integer
12540 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12541 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12542 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12543 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012544 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12545
12546 Example :
12547
12548 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12549 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012550
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012551env(<name>) : string
12552 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12553 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12554 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12555 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12556 certain way.
12557
12558 Examples :
12559 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12560 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12561
12562 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12563 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012565fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12566 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012567 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12568 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012569 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12570 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12571 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12572 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12573 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012575fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
12576 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12577 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12578 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
12579 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
12580 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
12581 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
12582 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
12583 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012584
12585 Example :
12586 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
12587 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
12588 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
12589 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
12590 frontend mail
12591 bind :25
12592 mode tcp
12593 maxconn 100
12594 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
12595 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
12596 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
12597 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012598
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012599int(<integer>) : signed integer
12600 Returns a signed integer.
12601
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012602ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
12603 Returns an ipv4.
12604
12605ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
12606 Returns an ipv6.
12607
12608meth(<method>) : method
12609 Returns a method.
12610
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012611nbproc : integer
12612 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
12613 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
12614 and debugging purposes.
12615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012616nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
12617 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
12618 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
12619 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012620 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
12621 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
12622 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010012623
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012624proc : integer
12625 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
12626 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
12627 debugging purposes.
12628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012629queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012630 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
12631 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
12632 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012633 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
12634 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
12635 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
12636 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
12637 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
12638
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010012639rand([<range>]) : integer
12640 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
12641 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
12642 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
12643 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
12644 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
12645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012646srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12647 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12648 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
12649 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
12650 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
12651 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
12652 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
12653 methods.
12654
12655srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
12656 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
12657 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
12658 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
12659 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
12660 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
12661 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
12662 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
12663
12664srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
12665 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12666 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012667 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012668 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
12669 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
12670 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
12671 overloading servers).
12672
12673 Example :
12674 # Redirect to a separate back
12675 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
12676 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
12677 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
12678
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010012679stopping : boolean
12680 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
12681 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
12682 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
12683
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012684str(<string>) : string
12685 Returns a string.
12686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012687table_avl([<table>]) : integer
12688 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
12689 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
12690
12691table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12692 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
12693 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
12694 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
12695
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012696var(<var-name>) : undefined
12697 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012698 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
12699 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12700 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12701 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012702 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012703 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12704 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012705 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12706 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9' and '_'.
12707
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200127087.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012709----------------------------------
12710
12711The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
12712closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
12713methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
12714sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
12715TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012716the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
12717counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
12718"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012719argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
12720the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
12721this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012722
12723be_id : integer
12724 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
12725 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
12726
12727dst : ip
12728 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
12729 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
12730 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
12731 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
12732 RFC 4291.
12733
12734dst_conn : integer
12735 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
12736 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
12737 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
12738 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
12739 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
12740 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
12741 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
12742 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012743
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020012744dst_is_local : boolean
12745 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
12746 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
12747 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
12748 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
12749 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
12750 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
12751 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
12752 it only once per connection.
12753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012754dst_port : integer
12755 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
12756 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
12757 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
12758 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
12759 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
12760 an HTTP header.
12761
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020012762fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
12763 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
12764 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
12765 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
12766 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12767 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12768 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12769
12770fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
12771 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
12772 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
12773 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
12774 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
12775 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
12776 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12777
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070012778fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
12779 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12780 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12781 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12782 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12783
12784fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
12785 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
12786 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
12787 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
12788 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12789
12790fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
12791 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
12792 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12793 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12794 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12795
12796fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
12797 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
12798 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12799 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12800 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12801
12802fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
12803 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
12804 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12805 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12806 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12807
12808fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
12809 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
12810 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
12811 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
12812 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
12813
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012814fe_id : integer
12815 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
12816 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
12817 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
12818
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012819sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012820sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12821sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
12822sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012823 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
12824 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12825 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
12826
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012827sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012828sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12829sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
12830sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012831 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
12832 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
12833 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
12834
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012835sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012836sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12837sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12838sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012839 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
12840 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012841 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
12842 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
12843 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012844
12845 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
12846 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012847 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12848 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
12849 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020012850 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
12851 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12852
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012853sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012854sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12855sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12856sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012857 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
12858 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
12859
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012860sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012861sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12862sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
12863sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012864 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
12865 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
12866 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
12867
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012868sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012869sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12870sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
12871sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012872 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
12873 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
12874 See also src_conn_rate.
12875
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012876sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012877sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12878sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12879sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012880 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012881 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012882
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012883sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
12884sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12885sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12886sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
12887 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
12888 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
12889
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012890sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012891sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12892sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
12893sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012894 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12895 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
12896 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020012897 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
12898 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
12899 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012900
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012901sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012902sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12903sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12904sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012905 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
12906 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
12907 See also src_http_err_cnt.
12908
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012909sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012910sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12911sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
12912sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012913 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
12914 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
12915 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
12916 src_http_err_rate.
12917
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012918sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012919sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12920sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12921sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012922 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12923 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12924 src_http_req_cnt.
12925
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012926sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012927sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12928sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
12929sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012930 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
12931 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
12932 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
12933 src_http_req_rate.
12934
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012935sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012936sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12937sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
12938sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012939 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010012940 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
12941 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
12942 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
12943 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012944
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012945 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
12946 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012947 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
12948
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012949sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012950sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12951sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
12952sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012953 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
12954 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12955 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012956
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012957sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012958sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12959sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
12960sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020012961 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
12962 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
12963 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012964
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012965sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012966sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12967sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
12968sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012969 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
12970 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
12971 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
12972 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012973 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012974 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
12975
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012976sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012977sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12978sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
12979sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012980 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
12981 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
12982 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
12983 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
12984 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012985 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012986
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012987sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012988sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12989sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
12990sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020012991 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
12992 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
12993 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
12994
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020012995sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020012996sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12997sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
12998sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010012999 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13000 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013001 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013002 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13003 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13005 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13006 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013008so_id : integer
13009 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13010 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13011 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013013src : ip
13014 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13015 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13016 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13017 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013018 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13019 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13020 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13021 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013022
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013023 Example:
13024 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13025 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013027src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13028 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13029 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13030 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013031 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013033src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13034 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13035 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013036 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013037 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13040 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13041 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13042 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13043 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13044 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13045 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013046
13047 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13048 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13049 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13050 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013051 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013052 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13053 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13054
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013055src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013056 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013058 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013059 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013061src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013062 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013063 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13064 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013065 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013067src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13068 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13069 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13070 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013071 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013073src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013074 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013075 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013076 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013077 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013078
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013079src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13080 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13081 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13082 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13083 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013086 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013087 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013088 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13089 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013090 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13091 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13092 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013094src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13095 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13096 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013097 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013098 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013099 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13102 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13103 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13104 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13105 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013106 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013108src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13109 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13110 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13111 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013112 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13115 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13116 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13117 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013118 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013119 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013121src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13122 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13123 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13124 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013125 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13127 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013128
13129 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013130 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013131 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013132
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013133src_is_local : boolean
13134 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13135 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13136 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13137 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13138 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13139 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13140 once per connection.
13141
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013142src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013143 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13144 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13145 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13146 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13147 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013150 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13151 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13152 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13153 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13154 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156src_port : integer
13157 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13158 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13159 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13160 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013162src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13163 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013164 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13165 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13166 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013167 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013169src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13170 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13171 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13172 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13173 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013174 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013176src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13177 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13178 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13179 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13180 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13181 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13182 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13183 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13184 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013185
13186 Example :
13187 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13188 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13189 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13190 listen ssh
13191 bind :22
13192 mode tcp
13193 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013194 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013195 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013196 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013198srv_id : integer
13199 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13200 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13201 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013202
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132037.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013204----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013206The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13207closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13208when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13209usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013210future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013211
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013212ssl_bc : boolean
13213 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13214 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13215 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13216
13217ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13218 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13219 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13220
13221ssl_bc_cipher : string
13222 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13223 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13224
13225ssl_bc_protocol : string
13226 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13227 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13228
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013229ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013230 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013231 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13232 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013233
13234ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13235 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13236 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13237 if session was reused or not.
13238
13239ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13240 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13241 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013243ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13244 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13245 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13246 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13247 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13248 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013250ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13251 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13252 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13253 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13254 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013255
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013256ssl_c_der : binary
13257 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13258 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13259 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013261ssl_c_err : integer
13262 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13263 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13264 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13265 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13266 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013268ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13269 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13270 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13271 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13272 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13273 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13274 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13275 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13276 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013278ssl_c_key_alg : string
13279 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13280 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13281 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013283ssl_c_notafter : string
13284 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13285 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13286 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013288ssl_c_notbefore : string
13289 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13290 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13291 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13294 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13295 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13296 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13297 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13298 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13299 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13300 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13301 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013303ssl_c_serial : binary
13304 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13305 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13306 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013307
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013308ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13309 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13310 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13311 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013312 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13313 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13314
13315 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013317ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13318 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13319 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13320 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013322ssl_c_used : boolean
13323 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13324 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013326ssl_c_verify : integer
13327 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13328 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13329 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13330 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013332ssl_c_version : integer
13333 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13334 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013335
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013336ssl_f_der : binary
13337 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13338 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13339 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013341ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13342 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13343 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13344 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13345 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013346 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013347 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13348 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13349 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013350
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351ssl_f_key_alg : string
13352 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13353 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13354 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013356ssl_f_notafter : string
13357 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13358 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13359 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361ssl_f_notbefore : string
13362 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13363 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13364 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013366ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13367 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13368 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13369 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13370 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13371 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13372 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13373 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13374 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013376ssl_f_serial : binary
13377 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13378 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13379 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013380
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013381ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13382 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13383 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13384 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013386ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13387 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13388 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13389 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013391ssl_f_version : integer
13392 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13393 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13394
13395ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013396 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13397 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13398 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400 Example :
13401 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13402 listen http-https
13403 bind :80
13404 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13405 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13406
13407ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13408 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13409 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13410
13411ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013412 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013413 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13414 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13415 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13416 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13417 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13418 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13419 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13420 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013422ssl_fc_cipher : string
13423 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13424 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013426ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013427 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13428 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013429 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13430 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13431 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13432 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013434ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13435 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013436 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13437 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13438 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13439 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013440
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013441ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013442 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13443 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13444
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013445ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013446 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13448 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13449 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13450 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13451 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13452 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13453 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013455ssl_fc_protocol : string
13456 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13457 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013458
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013459ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013460 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013461 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13462 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13465 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13466 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13467 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13468 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470ssl_fc_sni : string
13471 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13472 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13473 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13474 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13475 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13476
13477 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13478 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13479 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013480 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13481 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013483 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013484 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13485 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013487ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13488 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13489 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013490
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200134927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013493------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013495Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13496sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13497only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13498For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13499be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13500can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13501sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13502for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13503content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013505payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13506 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13507 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13508 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013510payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13511 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13512 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13513 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013514
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013515req.len : integer
13516req_len : integer (deprecated)
13517 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13518 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13519 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13520 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13521 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13522 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13523 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
13524 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013526req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13527 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013528 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13529 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13530 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13531 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013533 ACL alternatives :
13534 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013535
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013536req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13537 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13538 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13539 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
13540 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542 ACL alternatives :
13543 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013545 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013547req.proto_http : boolean
13548req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
13549 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
13550 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
13551 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
13552 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
13553 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
13554 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
13555 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557 Example:
13558 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13559 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13560 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013561 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020013562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
13564rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13565 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
13566 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
13567 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
13568 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
13569 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
13570 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
13571 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013573 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
13574 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
13575 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
13576 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
13577 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
13578 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013580 ACL derivatives :
13581 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013583 Example :
13584 listen tse-farm
13585 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
13586 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
13587 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13588 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
13589 # apply RDP cookie persistence
13590 persist rdp-cookie
13591 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
13592 # This is only useful makes sense if
13593 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
13594 stick-table type string size 204800
13595 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
13596 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
13597 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013599 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
13600 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013602req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
13603rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
13604 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
13605 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
13606 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
13607 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013609 ACL derivatives :
13610 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013611
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013612req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
13613 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
13614 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013615 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
13616 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
13617 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
13618 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
13619 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020013620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013621req.ssl_hello_type : integer
13622req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13623 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13624 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
13625 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13626 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13627 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
13628 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13629 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013631req.ssl_sni : string
13632req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
13633 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
13634 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
13635 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
13636 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13637 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13638 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
13639 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
13640 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
13641 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
13642 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
13643 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
13644 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013645
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013646 ACL derivatives :
13647 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649 Examples :
13650 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
13651 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13652 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
13653 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
13654 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020013655
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053013656req.ssl_st_ext : integer
13657 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
13658 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
13659 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
13660 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
13661 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
13662 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
13663 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
13664 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
13665 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
13666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013667req.ssl_ver : integer
13668req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
13669 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
13670 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
13671 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
13672 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
13673 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
13674 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
13675 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
13676 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
13677 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013679 ACL derivatives :
13680 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013681
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020013682res.len : integer
13683 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
13684 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
13685 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
13686 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
13687 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
13688 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
13689 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
13690 content inspection.
13691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013692res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
13693 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020013694 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
13695 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
13696 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
13697 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013699res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
13700 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
13701 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
13702 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
13703 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013705 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013706
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020013707res.ssl_hello_type : integer
13708rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
13709 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
13710 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
13711 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
13712 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
13713 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
13714 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
13715 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
13716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013717wait_end : boolean
13718 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
13719 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
13720 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
13721 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
13722 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
13723 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
13724 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
13725 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013726
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013727 Examples :
13728 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
13729 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
13730 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013732 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
13733 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
13734 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
13735 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
13736 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
13737 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
13738 tcp-request content reject
13739
13740
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137417.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013742--------------------------------------
13743
13744It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
13745This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
13746data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
13747its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
13748HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
13749content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
13750to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
13751more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
13752response are indexed.
13753
13754base : string
13755 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
13756 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
13757 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
13758 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
13759 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
13760 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
13761 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
13762 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
13763
13764 ACL derivatives :
13765 base : exact string match
13766 base_beg : prefix match
13767 base_dir : subdir match
13768 base_dom : domain match
13769 base_end : suffix match
13770 base_len : length match
13771 base_reg : regex match
13772 base_sub : substring match
13773
13774base32 : integer
13775 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
13776 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
13777 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013778 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
13779 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
13780 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013781
13782base32+src : binary
13783 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
13784 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
13785 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
13786 per-URL counters.
13787
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013788capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
13789 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
13790 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13791 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
13792
13793capture.req.method : string
13794 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
13795 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
13796 because it's allocated.
13797
13798capture.req.uri : string
13799 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
13800 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
13801 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
13802 allocated.
13803
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013804capture.req.ver : string
13805 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13806 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
13807 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
13808
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010013809capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
13810 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
13811 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
13812 The first entry is an index of 0.
13813 See also: "capture response header"
13814
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020013815capture.res.ver : string
13816 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
13817 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
13818 persistent flag.
13819
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013820req.body : binary
13821 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
13822 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13823 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
13824 the first chunk is analyzed.
13825
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020013826req.body_param([<name>) : string
13827 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
13828 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
13829 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
13830 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
13831 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
13832 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
13833 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
13834 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
13835 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
13836 given.
13837
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020013838req.body_len : integer
13839 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
13840 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
13841 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
13842 "option http-buffer-request".
13843
13844req.body_size : integer
13845 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
13846 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
13847 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
13848 that the request body has been buffered made available using
13849 "option http-buffer-request".
13850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851req.cook([<name>]) : string
13852cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13853 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13854 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
13855 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
13856 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
13857 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
13858 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
13859 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
13860 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
13861
13862 ACL derivatives :
13863 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
13864 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
13865 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
13866 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
13867 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
13868 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
13869 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
13870 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013872req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13873cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13874 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
13875 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
13878cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
13879 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13880 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
13881 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
13882 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020013883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013884cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
13885 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
13886 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
13887 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
13888 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020013889 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013890 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
13891 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
13892 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
13893 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013895hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13896 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
13897 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
13898 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
13899 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013900 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
13903 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13904 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13905 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13906 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13907 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13908 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
13909 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
13910 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013911
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013912req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13913 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13914 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
13915 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
13916 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013918req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
13919 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
13920 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
13921 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13922 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13923 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13924 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
13925 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
13926 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
13927 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
13928 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
13929 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013931 ACL derivatives :
13932 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
13933 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
13934 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
13935 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
13936 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
13937 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
13938 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
13939 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
13940
13941req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
13942hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
13943 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
13944 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
13945 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
13946 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
13947 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
13948 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
13949 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
13950 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
13951 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
13952
13953req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
13954hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
13955 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
13956 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
13957 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
13958 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
13959 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
13960 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
13961 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
13962 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
13963
13964req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
13965hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
13966 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
13967 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
13968 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
13969 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
13970 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
13971 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
13972 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
13973
13974http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
13975 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
13976 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
13977 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13978 basic auth is supported.
13979
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013980http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
13981 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
13982 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
13983 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
13984 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013985 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
13986 basic auth is supported.
13987
13988 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010013989 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
13990 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
13991 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
13992 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993
13994http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013995 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
13996 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013997 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
13998 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020013999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014000method : integer + string
14001 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14002 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14003 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14004 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14005 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14006 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14007 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009 ACL derivatives :
14010 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014011
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014012 Example :
14013 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14014 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14015 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014016
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014017path : string
14018 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14019 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14020 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14021 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14022 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14023 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14024 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014026 ACL derivatives :
14027 path : exact string match
14028 path_beg : prefix match
14029 path_dir : subdir match
14030 path_dom : domain match
14031 path_end : suffix match
14032 path_len : length match
14033 path_reg : regex match
14034 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014035
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014036query : string
14037 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14038 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14039 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14040 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
14041 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the completemnt of "path"
14042 which stops before the question mark.
14043
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014044req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14045 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14046 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14047 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14048 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014050req.ver : string
14051req_ver : string (deprecated)
14052 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14053 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14054 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056 ACL derivatives :
14057 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014059res.comp : boolean
14060 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14061 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14062 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014064res.comp_algo : string
14065 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14066 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14067 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014069res.cook([<name>]) : string
14070scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14071 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14072 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14073 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014075 ACL derivatives :
14076 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14079scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14080 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14081 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14082 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014083
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014084res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14085scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14086 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14087 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14088 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14091 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14092 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14093 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14094 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14095 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14096 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14097 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14098 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14099 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014101res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14102 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14103 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14104 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14105 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14106 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14109shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14110 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14111 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14112 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14113 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14114 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14115 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14116 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14117 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119 ACL derivatives :
14120 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14121 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14122 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14123 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14124 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14125 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14126 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14127 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14128
14129res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14130shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14131 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14132 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14133 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14134 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14135 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014137res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14138shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14139 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14140 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14141 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14142 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14143 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14144 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014145
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014146res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14147 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14148 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14149 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14150 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14151
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014152res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14153shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14154 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14155 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14156 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14157 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14158 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14159 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014161res.ver : string
14162resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14163 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14164 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166 ACL derivatives :
14167 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014169set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14170 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14171 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014172 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014173 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14176 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014178status : integer
14179 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14180 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14181 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014182
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014183unique-id : string
14184 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14185 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14186 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14187 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14188 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14189 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014191url : string
14192 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14193 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14194 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14195 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14196 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14197 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14198 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200 ACL derivatives :
14201 url : exact string match
14202 url_beg : prefix match
14203 url_dir : subdir match
14204 url_dom : domain match
14205 url_end : suffix match
14206 url_len : length match
14207 url_reg : regex match
14208 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210url_ip : ip
14211 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14212 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14213 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14214 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14215 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14216 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14217 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014219url_port : integer
14220 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14221 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14222 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14223 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014224
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014225urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14226url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014227 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14228 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014229 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14230 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14231 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14232 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014233 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14234 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014235 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14236 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014237
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014238 ACL derivatives :
14239 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14240 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14241 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14242 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14243 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14244 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14245 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14246 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014247
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014249 Example :
14250 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14251 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14252 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14253 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014254
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014255urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014256 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14257 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14258 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014259
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014260url32 : integer
14261 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14262 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14263 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14264 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14265 is an unsigned integer.
14266
14267url32+src : binary
14268 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14269 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14270 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14271
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200142737.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014274---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014276Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14277every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014278order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014280ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14281---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014282FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014283HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014284HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14285HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014286HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14287HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14288HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14289HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14290LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014291METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014292METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014293METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14294METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14295METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14296METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014297METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014298METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014299RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014300REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014301TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014302WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14303---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014304
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014305
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143068. Logging
14307----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014308
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014309One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14310provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14311very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14312provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14313state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014314to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014315headers.
14316
14317In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14318about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14319send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14320
14321 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14322 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14323 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14324 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14325 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014326 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14327 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014328
14329The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14330allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14331as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14332while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14333real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14334delay.
14335
14336
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143378.1. Log levels
14338---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014339
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014340TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014341source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014342HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14343in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14344track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14345syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14346about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014347
14348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143498.2. Log formats
14350----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014351
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014352HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014353and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14354slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14355options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014356
14357 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14358 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14359 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14360 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14361 extents.
14362
14363 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14364 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14365 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14366 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14367 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14368
14369 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14370 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14371 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14372 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14373 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14374
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014375 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14376 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14377 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14378 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14379
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014380 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14381
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014382Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14383specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14384field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14385servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14386always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14387identifier.
14388
14389Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14390 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14391 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14392 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14393 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14394
14395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143968.2.1. Default log format
14397-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014398
14399This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14400as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14401format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14402
14403 Example :
14404 listen www
14405 mode http
14406 log global
14407 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14408
14409 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14410 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14411 (www/HTTP)
14412
14413 Field Format Extract from the example above
14414 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14415 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14416 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14417 4 'to' to
14418 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14419 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14420
14421Detailed fields description :
14422 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14423 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14424 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14425 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14426 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14427 and processed the connection.
14428 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14429
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014430In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14431"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14432connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14433
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014434It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14435will eventually disappear.
14436
14437
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200144388.2.2. TCP log format
14439---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014440
14441The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14442is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14443information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14444counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14445emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14446environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14447the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14448sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014449specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14450not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14451fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14452marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014453
14454 Example :
14455 frontend fnt
14456 mode tcp
14457 option tcplog
14458 log global
14459 default_backend bck
14460
14461 backend bck
14462 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14463
14464 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14465 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14466 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14467
14468 Field Format Extract from the example above
14469 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14470 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14471 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14472 4 frontend_name fnt
14473 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14474 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14475 7 bytes_read* 212
14476 8 termination_state --
14477 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14478 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14479
14480Detailed fields description :
14481 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014482 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14483 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14484 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014485 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14486 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14487 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014488
14489 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014490 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14491 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14492 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014493
14494 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14495 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14496 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14497 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14498
14499 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14500 and processed the connection.
14501
14502 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14503 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14504 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14505 applications.
14506
14507 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14508 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14509 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14510 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14511 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14512
14513 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14514 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14515 See "Timers" below for more details.
14516
14517 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14518 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14519 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
14520 "Timers" below for more details.
14521
14522 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014523 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014524 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
14525 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
14526 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
14527 details.
14528
14529 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
14530 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
14531 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
14532 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
14533 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
14534
14535 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14536 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14537 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
14538 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
14539 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
14540 for more details.
14541
14542 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014543 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014544 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
14545 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
14546 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014547 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014548
14549 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14550 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14551 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14552 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14553 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14554 caused by a denial of service attack.
14555
14556 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14557 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14558 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14559 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14560 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14561 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14562 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14563 denial of service attack.
14564
14565 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14566 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14567 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14568 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14569 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14570 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14571 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14572 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
14573 be processed than on other servers.
14574
14575 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14576 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14577 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14578 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14579 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14580 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14581 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14582 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14583 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14584 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14585 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14586 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14587 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14588
14589 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14590 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14591 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14592 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14593 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14594 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14595 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14596 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14597
14598 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14599 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14600 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14601 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14602 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14603 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14604 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14605 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14606 occurs.
14607
14608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200146098.2.3. HTTP log format
14610----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014611
14612The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
14613is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
14614the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
14615are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
14616emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
14617generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
14618"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
14619which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014620frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
14621is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014622
14623Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
14624slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
14625with a star ('*') after the field name below.
14626
14627 Example :
14628 frontend http-in
14629 mode http
14630 option httplog
14631 log global
14632 default_backend bck
14633
14634 backend static
14635 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14636
14637 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
14638 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
14639 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014640 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014641
14642 Field Format Extract from the example above
14643 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
14644 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014645 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014646 4 frontend_name http-in
14647 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014648 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014649 7 status_code 200
14650 8 bytes_read* 2750
14651 9 captured_request_cookie -
14652 10 captured_response_cookie -
14653 11 termination_state ----
14654 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
14655 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14656 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
14657 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
14658 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014659
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014660Detailed fields description :
14661 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014662 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14663 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14664 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014665 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14666 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14667 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014668
14669 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014670 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14671 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14672 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014673
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014674 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
14675 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014676
14677 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14678 and processed the connection.
14679
14680 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14681 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14682 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
14683
14684 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14685 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14686 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14687 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
14688 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
14689 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
14690
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014691 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
14692 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
14693 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
14694 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
14695 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
14696 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
14697 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014698
14699 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14700 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14701 See "Timers" below for more details.
14702
14703 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
14704 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
14705 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
14706 below for more details.
14707
14708 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
14709 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
14710 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
14711 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
14712 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
14713 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
14714 for more details.
14715
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014716 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
14717 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
14718 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
14719 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
14720 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
14721 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
14722 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
14723 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014724
14725 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
14726 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
14727 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
14728
14729 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
14730 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
14731 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
14732 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
14733 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
14734 overflowing.
14735
14736 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
14737 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
14738 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
14739 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
14740 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
14741 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
14742 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
14743 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14744
14745 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
14746 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
14747 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
14748 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
14749 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
14750 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
14751 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
14752 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
14753
14754 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
14755 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
14756 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
14757 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
14758 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
14759 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
14760 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
14761
14762 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014763 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014764 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
14765 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
14766 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014767 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014768 system.
14769
14770 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
14771 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
14772 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
14773 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
14774 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
14775 caused by a denial of service attack.
14776
14777 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
14778 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
14779 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
14780 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
14781 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
14782 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
14783 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
14784 denial of service attack.
14785
14786 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
14787 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
14788 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
14789 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
14790 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
14791 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
14792 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
14793 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
14794 processed than on other servers.
14795
14796 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
14797 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
14798 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
14799 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
14800 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
14801 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
14802 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
14803 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
14804 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
14805 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
14806 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
14807 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
14808 should not be attributed to the logged server.
14809
14810 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14811 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
14812 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
14813 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
14814 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
14815 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
14816 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
14817 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
14818
14819 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
14820 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
14821 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
14822 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
14823 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
14824 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
14825 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
14826 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
14827 occurs.
14828
14829 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
14830 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
14831 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
14832 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
14833 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
14834 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
14835 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
14836 cookies" below for more details.
14837
14838 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
14839 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
14840 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
14841 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
14842 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
14843 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
14844 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
14845 and cookies" below for more details.
14846
14847 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
14848 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
14849 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
14850 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
14851 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
14852 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
14853 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
14854 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
14855
14856
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200148578.2.4. Custom log format
14858------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014859
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014860The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014861mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014862
14863HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
14864Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
14865separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
14866prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
14867
14868Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
14869variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014870("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014871
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014872If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020014873as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010014874less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
14875the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
14876
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014877Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014878In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010014879in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014880
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014881Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
14882'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
14883https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
14884such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
14885
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014886Flags are :
14887 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014888 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014889 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
14890 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014891
14892 Example:
14893
14894 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
14895 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
14896
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010014897 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
14898
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014899At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
14900
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014901 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
14902 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014903
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014904the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014905
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014906 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
14907 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
14908 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014909
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014910and the default TCP format is defined this way :
14911
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014912 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
14913 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014914
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014915Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
14916
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014917 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014918 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014919 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
14920 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
14921 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014922 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
14923 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
14924 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014925 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014926 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
14927 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000014928 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000014929 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
14930 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014931 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020014932 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014933 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014934 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014935 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020014936 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080014937 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014938 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
14939 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
14940 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
14941 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
14942 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014943 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014944 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
14945 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014946 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014947 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
14948 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014949 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14950 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
14951 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014952 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014953 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
14954 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014955 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014956 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
14957 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
14958 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020014959 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020014960 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020014961 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
14962 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
14963 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
14964 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020014965 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020014966 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014967 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014968 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010014969 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014970 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014971 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
14972 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
14973 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014974 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014975 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
14976 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010014977 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020014978 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
14979 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
14980 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014981 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014982 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010014983 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014984
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020014985 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014986
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010014987
149888.2.5. Error log format
14989-----------------------
14990
14991When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
14992protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
14993By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
14994"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
14995will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
14996logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
14997
14998The format looks like this :
14999
15000 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15001 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15002 Connection error during SSL handshake
15003
15004 Field Format Extract from the example above
15005 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15006 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15007 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15008 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15009 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15010
15011These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15012failures.
15013
15014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150158.3. Advanced logging options
15016-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015017
15018Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15019just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15020options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15021for more information about their usage.
15022
15023
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150248.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15025------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015026
15027It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15028haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15029commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15030monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15031ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15032
15033 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15034 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15035 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15036 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15037
15038 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15039 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15040 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015041 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015042 such as other load-balancers.
15043
15044 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15045 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15046 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15047
15048
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150498.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15050----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015051
15052The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15053what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15054or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15055"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15056just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15057log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15058after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15059is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15060with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15061with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15062
15063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150648.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15065------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015066
15067Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15068for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15069"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15070retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15071raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15072a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15073file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15074you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15075"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15076
15077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150788.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15079--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015080
15081Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15082multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15083them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15084"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15085logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15086error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15087and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15088too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15089useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15090alternative.
15091
15092
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150938.4. Timing events
15094------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015095
15096Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15097reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15098the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15099frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015100mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15101addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15102
15103 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15104 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15105 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15106 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15107 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15108 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15109 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015110
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015111 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15112 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15113 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15114 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15115 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15116 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15117 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15118 nothing was received on the connection.
15119
15120 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15121 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15122 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15123 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15124 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15125 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15126 request typed by hand during a test.
15127
15128 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15129 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15130 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15131 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15132 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15133 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15134 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015135
15136 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15137 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15138 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15139 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15140 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15141
15142 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15143 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15144 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15145 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15146 connection never established.
15147
15148 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15149 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15150 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15151 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15152 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15153 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15154 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15155 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15156 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15157 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15158 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15159
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015160 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15161 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15162 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15163 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15164 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15165 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15166
15167 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15168
15169 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15170 "Ta" can never be negative.
15171
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015172 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15173 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015174 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15175 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015176 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015177
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015178 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015179
15180 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015181 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15182 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015183
15184These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15185protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15186that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015187due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15188"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15189that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015190
15191Most common cases :
15192
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015193 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15194 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15195 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15196 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15197 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15198 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15199 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15200 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15201 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15202 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15203 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015204 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015205
15206 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15207 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15208 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15209 of ms on remote networks.
15210
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015211 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15212 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15213 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015214
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015215 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15216 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15217 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15218 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15219 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15220 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15221 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15222 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15223 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015224
15225Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15226
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015227 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015228 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015229 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015231 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015232 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15233 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15234
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015235 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015236 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15237 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15238 flags.
15239
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015240 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15241 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015242 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15243 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15244 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15245 the client connection was maintained open.
15246
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015247 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015248 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015249 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015250 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15251
15252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152538.5. Session state at disconnection
15254-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015255
15256TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15257"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
152582-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15259each of which has a special meaning :
15260
15261 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15262 session to terminate :
15263
15264 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15265
15266 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15267 server explicitly refused it.
15268
15269 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15270 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15271 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15272 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015273 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15274
15275 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15276 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015277
15278 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15279 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15280 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15281 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15282 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15283
15284 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15285 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15286 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15287 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15288 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15289
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015290 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15291 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15292
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015293 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15294 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15295 backup connections when going up.
15296
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015297 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15298
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015299 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15300 send or receive data.
15301
15302 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15303 send or receive data.
15304
15305 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15306 with nothing left in the buffers.
15307
15308 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15309
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015310 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015311 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15312
15313 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15314 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15315 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15316 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15317 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15318
15319 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15320 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15321
15322 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15323 server (HTTP only).
15324
15325 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15326
15327 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15328 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15329 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15330
15331 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15332 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15333 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15334
15335 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15336
15337 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15338 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15339
15340 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15341 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15342 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15343
15344 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15345 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015346 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15347 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015348
15349 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15350 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15351 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15352 another server.
15353
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015354 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015355 server.
15356
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015357 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15358 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15359 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15360 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15361
15362 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15363 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15364 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15365 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15366
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015367 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15368 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15369 "use-server" rule).
15370
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015371 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15372
15373 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15374 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15375
15376 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15377
15378 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15379 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15380 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15381
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015382 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15383 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015384 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015385 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15386 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15387
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015388 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15389
15390 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15391 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15392
15393 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15394
15395 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15396
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015397The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15398was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015399helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15400starvation, attacks, etc...
15401
15402The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15403alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15404easier finding and understanding.
15405
15406 Flags Reason
15407
15408 -- Normal termination.
15409
15410 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15411 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15412 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15413 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15414
15415 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15416 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15417 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15418 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15419 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15420 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015421
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015422 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15423 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015424 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015425
15426 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15427 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15428 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15429
15430 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15431 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15432 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15433 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15434 the server takes too long to respond.
15435
15436 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15437 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15438 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15439 long a time to respond.
15440
15441 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15442 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15443 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15444 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015445 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15446 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015447
15448 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15449 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15450 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15451 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15452 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015453 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015454 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15455 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15456 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15457 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15458 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15459 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15460 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15461 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15462 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15463 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15464 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15465 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015466
15467 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15468 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015469 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15470 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15471 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15472 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015473
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015474 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15475 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015477 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015478 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15479 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15480 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15481 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15482 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15483
15484 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15485 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15486 503 or 504 here.
15487
15488 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15489 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15490 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15491 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15492 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15493
15494 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15495 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015496 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015497 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
15498 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
15499
15500 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
15501 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
15502 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
15503 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
15504 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
15505 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
15506 between haproxy and the server.
15507
15508 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
15509 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
15510 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
15511 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
15512 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
15513 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
15514 solution is to fix the application.
15515
15516 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
15517 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
15518 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
15519 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
15520 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
15521 external attacks.
15522
15523 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
15524 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015525 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015526 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
15527 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
15528
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015529 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
15530 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
15531 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020015532 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
15533 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015534
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015535 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
15536 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
15537 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
15538 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010015539 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
15540 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
15541 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
15542 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
15543 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015544
15545 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
15546 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
15547 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
15548 returned an HTTP 403 error.
15549
15550 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
15551 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
15552 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
15553 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
15554
15555 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
15556 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
15557 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
15558 only be solved by proper system tuning.
15559
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015560The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
15561persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
15562important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
15563re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
15564
15565 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
15566
15567 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15568 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
15569 set on a GET request.
15570
15571 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
15572 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015573 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015574 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
15575
15576 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
15577 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
15578 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
15579
15580 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
15581 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
15582 already got a cookie.
15583
15584 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15585 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
15586 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
15587 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
15588 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
15589
15590 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
15591 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15592 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15593
15594 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
15595 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
15596 new cookie was inserted in the response.
15597
15598 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
15599 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
15600
15601 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
15602 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
15603 then advertised in the response.
15604
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015605
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156068.6. Non-printable characters
15607-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015608
15609In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
15610consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
15611converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
15612prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
15613being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
15614escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
15615is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
15616'}' when logging headers.
15617
15618Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
15619issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
15620containing spaces is "User-Agent".
15621
15622Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
15623the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
15624performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
15625
15626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
15628---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015629
15630Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
15631achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015632section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015633cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
15634the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
15635the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015636locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015637not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
15638user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
15639a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
15640wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
15641
15642 Examples :
15643 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
15644 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
15645
15646 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
15647 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
15648
15649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
15651---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015652
15653Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
15654proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
15655the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
15656server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
15657
15658Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
15659response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015660section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015661
15662It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015663time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
15664appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015665are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
15666and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
15667follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
15668request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
15669in the logs.
15670
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015671As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
15672frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
15673an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
15674
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015675 Example :
15676 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
15677 listen proxy-out
15678 mode http
15679 option httplog
15680 option logasap
15681 log global
15682 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
15683
15684 # log the name of the virtual server
15685 capture request header Host len 20
15686
15687 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
15688 capture request header Content-Length len 10
15689
15690 # log the beginning of the referrer
15691 capture request header Referer len 20
15692
15693 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
15694 capture response header Server len 20
15695
15696 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
15697 capture response header Content-Length len 10
15698
15699 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
15700 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
15701
15702 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
15703 capture response header Via len 20
15704
15705 # log the URL location during a redirection
15706 capture response header Location len 20
15707
15708 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
15709 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
15710 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15711 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
15712 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
15713
15714 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15715 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15716 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15717 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015718 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015719
15720 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
15721 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
15722 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
15723 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
15724 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015725 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015726
15727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157288.9. Examples of logs
15729---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015730
15731These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
15732them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
15733reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
15734
15735 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
15736 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15737 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15738
15739 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
15740 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
15741
15742 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
15743 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
15744 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
15745
15746 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
15747 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
15748
15749 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
15750 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
15751 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
15752
15753 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015754 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015755 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
15756 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
15757
15758 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
15759 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
15760 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
15761
15762 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
15763 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020015764 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015765 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
15766 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
15767 to return the 502 and not the server.
15768
15769 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015770 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015771
15772 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
15773 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
15774 Nothing was sent to any server.
15775
15776 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
15777 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
15778
15779 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
15780 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
15781 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
15782 send a 408 return code to the client.
15783
15784 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
15785 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
15786
15787 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
15788 5 seconds ("c----").
15789
15790 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
15791 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015792 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015793
15794 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015795 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015796 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
15797 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
15798 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
15799 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
15800 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015801
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020015802
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200158039. Supported filters
15804--------------------
15805
15806Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
15807accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
15808unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
15809
15810See also : "filter"
15811
158129.1. Trace
15813----------
15814
15815filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding]
15816
15817 Arguments:
15818 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
15819 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
15820
15821 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
15822 the client and the server. By default, this filter
15823 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
15824 only parses a random amount of the available data.
15825
15826 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
15827 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
15828 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
15829 amount of the parsed data.
15830
15831This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
15832callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
15833information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
15834filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
15835
15836Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
15837tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
15838a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
15839
15840
158419.2. HTTP compression
15842---------------------
15843
15844filter compression
15845
15846The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
15847keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
15848when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
15849use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
15850used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
15851filters evaluation order.
15852
15853See also : "compression"
15854
15855
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015856/*
15857 * Local variables:
15858 * fill-column: 79
15859 * End:
15860 */